blob: 986bb8c3d2cb8bc339b888272bb0d4763e47b409 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00001//===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Chandler Carruth3a022472012-12-04 09:13:33 +000015#include "CXXABI.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000016#include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17#include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +000018#include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000019#include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
Dmitri Gribenkoca7f80a2012-08-09 00:03:17 +000020#include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
Steve Naroff67391b82007-10-01 19:00:59 +000022#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorded2d7b2009-02-04 19:02:06 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +000027#include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000028#include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
29#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +000030#include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
Chris Lattnerd2868512009-03-28 03:45:20 +000031#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner4dc8a6f2007-05-20 23:50:58 +000032#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000033#include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +000034#include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramerea70eb32012-12-01 15:09:41 +000035#include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +000036#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Benjamin Kramer1402ce32009-10-24 09:57:09 +000037#include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +000038#include <map>
Anders Carlssona4267a62009-07-18 21:19:52 +000039
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +000040using namespace clang;
41
Douglas Gregor9672f922010-07-03 00:47:00 +000042unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
43unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregora6d69502010-07-02 23:41:54 +000044unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
45unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000046unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
47unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor330b9cf2010-07-02 21:50:04 +000048unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
49unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Alexis Huntfcaeae42011-05-25 20:50:04 +000050unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
51unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +000052unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
53unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
54
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000055enum FloatingRank {
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +000056 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +000057};
58
Dmitri Gribenkof26054f2012-07-11 21:38:39 +000059RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +000060 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
61 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
62 CommentsLoaded = true;
63 }
64
65 assert(D);
66
Dmitri Gribenkodf17d642012-06-28 16:19:39 +000067 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
68 if (D->isImplicit())
69 return NULL;
70
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +000071 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
72 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
73 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
74 return NULL;
75 }
76
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000077 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
78 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
79 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
80 return NULL;
81 }
82
83 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
84 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
85 return NULL;
86 }
87
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +000088 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
89 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
90 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
91 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
92 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
93 return NULL;
94 }
95
Dmitri Gribenkob1ad9932012-08-20 22:36:31 +000096 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
97 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
98 return NULL;
99 }
Fariborz Jahanian799a4032013-04-17 21:05:20 +0000100 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
101 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
102 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
103 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
104 return NULL;
105 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000106 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
107 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
108 return NULL;
109
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000110 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
111 // documentation.
112 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
113 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
114 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
115 return NULL;
116
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000117 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000118
119 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
120 if (RawComments.empty())
121 return NULL;
122
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000123 // Find declaration location.
124 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
125 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
126 // location".
127 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
128 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
129 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
130 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko34df2202012-07-31 22:37:06 +0000131 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
Dmitri Gribenko7f4b3772012-08-02 20:49:51 +0000132 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
133 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000134 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
135 else
136 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
137
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000138 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
139 // can't find the comment.
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000140 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
141 return NULL;
142
143 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000144 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
145 {
146 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
147 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
148 // first.
Dmitri Gribenkoa7d16ce2013-04-10 15:35:17 +0000149 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
150 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
151 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
Dmitri Gribenko82ea9472012-07-17 22:01:09 +0000152 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
153 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
154 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
155 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
156 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
157 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
158 }
159
160 if (Found) {
161 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
162 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
163 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
164 } else {
165 // Slow path.
166 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
167 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
168 }
169 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000170
171 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
172 // file buffer.
173 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
174
175 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
176 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000177 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
Dmitri Gribenko44cd7e62012-07-06 23:27:33 +0000178 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D))) {
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000179 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000180 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000181 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
182 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
183 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
184 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
185 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
186 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000187 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000188 }
189 }
190
191 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
192 // Let's look at the previous comment.
193 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
194 return NULL;
195 --Comment;
196
197 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000198 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000199 return NULL;
200
201 // Decompose the end of the comment.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000203 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000204
205 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
206 // aren't related.
207 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
208 return NULL;
209
210 // Get the corresponding buffer.
211 bool Invalid = false;
212 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
213 &Invalid).data();
214 if (Invalid)
215 return NULL;
216
217 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
218 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
219 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
220
Dmitri Gribenko7e8729b2012-06-27 23:43:37 +0000221 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
222 // comment and declaration.
Dmitri Gribenkoe7bb9442012-07-13 01:06:46 +0000223 if (Text.find_first_of(",;{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000224 return NULL;
225
Dmitri Gribenko7dd29d42012-07-06 18:19:34 +0000226 return *Comment;
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000227}
228
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000229namespace {
230/// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
231/// refer to the actual template.
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000232/// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000233const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000234 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000235 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000236 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000237 return FTD;
238
239 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
240 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
241 return D;
242
243 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
244 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
245 return FTD;
246
247 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
248 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
249 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
250 return MemberDecl;
251
252 return D;
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000253 }
Dmitri Gribenko90631802012-08-22 17:44:32 +0000254 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
255 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
256 // template?
257 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
258 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
259 return MemberDecl;
260
261 return D;
262 }
263 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
264 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
265 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
266 return CTD;
267
268 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
269 // specialization?
270 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
271 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
272 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
273 return D;
274 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
275 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
276 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
277 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
278 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
279 static_cast<const Decl*>(
280 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
281 }
282
283 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
284 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
285 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
286 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
287
288 return D;
289 }
290 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
291 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
292 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
293 return MemberDecl;
294
295 return D;
296 }
297 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000298 return D;
299}
300} // unnamed namespace
301
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000302const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
303 const Decl *D,
304 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000305 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Douglas Gregor35ceb272012-08-13 16:37:30 +0000306
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000307 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
308 {
309 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
310 RedeclComments.find(D);
311 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
312 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000313 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
314 if (OriginalDecl)
315 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000316 return Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000317 }
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000318 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000319 }
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000320
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000321 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
322 const RawComment *RC = NULL;
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000323 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = NULL;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000324 for (Decl::redecl_iterator I = D->redecls_begin(),
325 E = D->redecls_end();
326 I != E; ++I) {
327 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
328 RedeclComments.find(*I);
329 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
330 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
331 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
332 RC = Raw.getRaw();
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000333 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000334 break;
335 }
336 } else {
337 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(*I);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000338 OriginalDeclForRC = *I;
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000339 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
340 if (RC) {
341 Raw.setRaw(RC);
342 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
343 } else
344 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000345 Raw.setOriginalDecl(*I);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000346 RedeclComments[*I] = Raw;
347 if (RC)
348 break;
349 }
350 }
351
Dmitri Gribenko5c8897d2012-06-28 16:25:36 +0000352 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
353 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000354
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000355 if (OriginalDecl)
356 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
357
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000358 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
359 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
360 Raw.setRaw(RC);
361 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000362 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
Dmitri Gribenkoa43ec182012-08-11 00:51:43 +0000363
364 for (Decl::redecl_iterator I = D->redecls_begin(),
365 E = D->redecls_end();
366 I != E; ++I) {
367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[*I];
368 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
369 R = Raw;
370 }
371
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000372 return RC;
373}
374
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000375static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
376 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
377 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
378 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
379 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
380 if (!ID)
381 return;
382 // Add redeclared method here.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000383 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
384 Ext = ID->known_extensions_begin(),
385 ExtEnd = ID->known_extensions_end();
386 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000387 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +0000388 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000389 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
390 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
391 }
392 }
393}
394
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000395comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
396 const Decl *D) const {
397 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
398 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
399 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
400 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
401 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
402 comments::FullComment *CFC =
403 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
404 ThisDeclInfo);
405 return CFC;
406
407}
408
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000409comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
410 const Decl *D,
411 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000412 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000413
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000414 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
415 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
416 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000417
418 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000419 if (Canonical != D) {
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000420 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian42e31322012-10-11 23:52:50 +0000421 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000422 return CFC;
423 }
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000424 return Pos->second;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000425 }
426
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000427 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000428
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000429 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000430 if (!RC) {
431 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000432 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000433 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000434 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
435 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
436 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
437 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian37494a12013-01-12 00:28:34 +0000438 if (OMD)
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +0000439 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
440 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000441 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
442 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
443 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000444 }
Fariborz Jahanian6384fbb2013-05-02 15:44:16 +0000445 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000446 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000447 // does not have one of its own.
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000448 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
Dmitri Gribenko01b06512013-01-27 21:18:39 +0000449 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
450 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
451 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
Fariborz Jahanian66024d02013-01-25 23:08:39 +0000452 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
Fariborz Jahanian40abf342013-01-25 22:48:32 +0000453 }
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000454 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
455 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
456 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
457 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
458 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
459 }
460 }
461 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
462 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
463 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
464 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
465 }
466 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
467 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
468 return NULL;
469 // Check non-virtual bases.
470 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_const_iterator I =
471 RD->bases_begin(), E = RD->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000472 if (I->isVirtual() || (I->getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000473 continue;
474 QualType Ty = I->getType();
475 if (Ty.isNull())
476 continue;
477 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
478 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
479 continue;
480
481 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
482 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
483 }
484 }
485 // Check virtual bases.
486 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_const_iterator I =
487 RD->vbases_begin(), E = RD->vbases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanian5a2e4a22013-04-26 23:34:36 +0000488 if (I->getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
489 continue;
Fariborz Jahaniane970c1b2013-04-26 20:55:38 +0000490 QualType Ty = I->getType();
491 if (Ty.isNull())
492 continue;
493 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
494 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
495 continue;
496 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
497 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
498 }
499 }
500 }
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000501 return NULL;
Fariborz Jahanian1c883b92012-10-10 18:34:52 +0000502 }
503
Dmitri Gribenkobfda9f72012-08-22 18:12:19 +0000504 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
505 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
506 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
507 // different across redeclarations.
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000508 if (D != OriginalDecl)
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000509 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
Dmitri Gribenko4ae66a32012-08-16 18:19:43 +0000510
Dmitri Gribenko6743e042012-09-29 11:40:46 +0000511 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
Dmitri Gribenkob2610882012-08-14 17:17:18 +0000512 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
513 return FC;
Dmitri Gribenkoec925312012-07-06 00:28:32 +0000514}
515
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000516void
517ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
518 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
519 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
520 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000521 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000522
523 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
524 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
525 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
526 PEnd = Params->end();
527 P != PEnd; ++P) {
528 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
529 ID.AddInteger(0);
530 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
531 continue;
532 }
533
534 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
535 ID.AddInteger(1);
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000536 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000537 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000538 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
539 ID.AddBoolean(true);
540 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
Eli Friedman205a4292012-03-07 01:09:33 +0000541 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
542 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
543 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
544 }
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000545 } else
546 ID.AddBoolean(false);
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000547 continue;
548 }
549
550 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
551 ID.AddInteger(2);
552 Profile(ID, TTP);
553 }
554}
555
556TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
557ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +0000558 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000559 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
560 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
561 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
562 void *InsertPos = 0;
563 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
564 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
565 if (Canonical)
566 return Canonical->getParam();
567
568 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
569 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000570 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000571 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
572 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
573 PEnd = Params->end();
574 P != PEnd; ++P) {
575 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
576 CanonParams.push_back(
577 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnarab3185b02011-03-06 15:48:19 +0000578 SourceLocation(),
579 SourceLocation(),
580 TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000581 TTP->getIndex(), 0, false,
582 TTP->isParameterPack()));
583 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000584 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
585 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
586 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
587 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
588 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +0000589 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
590 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000591 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
592 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
593 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
594 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
595 }
596
597 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000598 SourceLocation(),
599 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000600 NTTP->getDepth(),
601 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
602 T,
603 TInfo,
604 ExpandedTypes.data(),
605 ExpandedTypes.size(),
606 ExpandedTInfos.data());
607 } else {
608 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +0000609 SourceLocation(),
610 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +0000611 NTTP->getDepth(),
612 NTTP->getPosition(), 0,
613 T,
614 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
615 TInfo);
616 }
617 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
618
619 } else
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000620 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
621 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
622 }
623
624 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
625 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
626 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
Douglas Gregorf5500772011-01-05 15:48:55 +0000627 TTP->getPosition(),
628 TTP->isParameterPack(),
629 0,
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +0000630 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
631 SourceLocation(),
632 CanonParams.data(),
633 CanonParams.size(),
634 SourceLocation()));
635
636 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
637 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
638 assert(Canonical == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
639 (void)Canonical;
640
641 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
642 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
643 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
644 return CanonTTP;
645}
646
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000647CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000648 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return 0;
649
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000650 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
651 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
652 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
John McCall86353412010-08-21 22:46:04 +0000653 return CreateARMCXXABI(*this);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +0000654 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64: // Same as Itanium at this level
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000655 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000656 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +0000657 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Charles Davis6bcb07a2010-08-19 02:18:14 +0000658 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
659 }
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +0000660 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +0000661}
662
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000663static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000664 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
665 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
666 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
667 // language-specific address space.
668 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
669 1, // opencl_global
670 2, // opencl_local
Peter Collingbournef44bdf92012-05-20 21:08:35 +0000671 3, // opencl_constant
672 4, // cuda_device
673 5, // cuda_constant
674 6 // cuda_shared
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000675 };
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000676 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000677 } else {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000678 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +0000679 }
680}
681
Douglas Gregor7018d5b2011-09-01 20:23:19 +0000682ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions& LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000683 const TargetInfo *t,
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000684 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
Chris Lattner15ba9492009-06-14 01:54:56 +0000685 Builtin::Context &builtins,
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000686 unsigned size_reserve,
687 bool DelayInitialization)
688 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()),
689 TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
690 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
691 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
692 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(0),
693 Int128Decl(0), UInt128Decl(0),
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +0000694 BuiltinVaListDecl(0),
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +0000695 ObjCIdDecl(0), ObjCSelDecl(0), ObjCClassDecl(0), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(0),
Fariborz Jahanianf2578572012-08-30 18:49:41 +0000696 BOOLDecl(0),
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +0000697 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(0), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(0),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000698 FILEDecl(0),
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +0000699 jmp_bufDecl(0), sigjmp_bufDecl(0), ucontext_tDecl(0),
700 BlockDescriptorType(0), BlockDescriptorExtendedType(0),
701 cudaConfigureCallDecl(0),
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +0000702 NullTypeSourceInfo(QualType()),
703 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000704 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000705 AddrSpaceMap(0), Target(t), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000706 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels),
707 BuiltinInfo(builtins),
708 DeclarationNames(*this),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +0000709 ExternalSource(0), Listener(0),
Dmitri Gribenkoaab83832012-06-20 00:34:58 +0000710 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
Dmitri Gribenkoacf2e782013-02-22 14:21:27 +0000711 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts),
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000712 LastSDM(0, 0),
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +0000713 UniqueBlockByRefTypeID(0)
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000714{
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000715 if (size_reserve > 0) Types.reserve(size_reserve);
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000716 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000717
718 if (!DelayInitialization) {
719 assert(t && "No target supplied for ASTContext initialization");
720 InitBuiltinTypes(*t);
721 }
Daniel Dunbar221fa942008-08-11 04:54:23 +0000722}
723
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000724ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
Ted Kremenekda4e0d32010-02-11 07:12:28 +0000725 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
726 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
727 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +0000728
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000729 // Call all of the deallocation functions.
730 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Deallocations.size(); I != N; ++I)
731 Deallocations[I].first(Deallocations[I].second);
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000732
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000733 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000734 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
735 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
736 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
737 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
738 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
739 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
740 R->Destroy(*this);
741
Ted Kremenek076baeb2010-06-08 23:00:58 +0000742 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
743 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
744 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
745 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
746 R->Destroy(*this);
747 }
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000748
749 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
750 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
751 A != AEnd; ++A)
752 A->second->~AttrVec();
753}
Douglas Gregorf21eb492009-03-26 23:50:42 +0000754
Douglas Gregor1a809332010-05-23 18:26:36 +0000755void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
756 Deallocations.push_back(std::make_pair(Callback, Data));
757}
758
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000759void
Dylan Noblesmithe2778992012-02-05 02:12:40 +0000760ASTContext::setExternalSource(OwningPtr<ExternalASTSource> &Source) {
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000761 ExternalSource.reset(Source.take());
762}
763
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000764void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000765 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
766 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +0000767
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000768 unsigned counts[] = {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000769#define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000770#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
771#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
772 0 // Extra
773 };
Douglas Gregorb1fe2c92009-04-07 17:20:56 +0000774
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000775 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
776 Type *T = Types[i];
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000777 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000778 }
779
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000780 unsigned Idx = 0;
781 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
782#define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
783 if (counts[Idx]) \
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000784 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
785 << " types\n"; \
Douglas Gregora30d0462009-05-26 14:40:08 +0000786 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
787 ++Idx;
788#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
789#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000790
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000791 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
792
Douglas Gregor7454c562010-07-02 20:37:36 +0000793 // Implicit special member functions.
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000794 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
795 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
796 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
797 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
798 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
799 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000800 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000801 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
802 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
803 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
804 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
805 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
806 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +0000807 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000808 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
809 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
810 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
811 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
812 << NumImplicitDestructors
813 << " implicit destructors created\n";
814
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000815 if (ExternalSource.get()) {
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000816 llvm::errs() << "\n";
Douglas Gregoref84c4b2009-04-09 22:27:44 +0000817 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
818 }
Chandler Carruth3c147a72011-07-04 05:32:14 +0000819
Douglas Gregor5b11d492010-07-25 17:53:33 +0000820 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000821}
822
Douglas Gregor801c99d2011-08-12 06:49:56 +0000823TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
824 if (!Int128Decl) {
825 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Int128Ty);
826 Int128Decl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
827 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
828 SourceLocation(),
829 SourceLocation(),
830 &Idents.get("__int128_t"),
831 TInfo);
832 }
833
834 return Int128Decl;
835}
836
837TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
838 if (!UInt128Decl) {
839 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnsignedInt128Ty);
840 UInt128Decl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
841 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
842 SourceLocation(),
843 SourceLocation(),
844 &Idents.get("__uint128_t"),
845 TInfo);
846 }
847
848 return UInt128Decl;
849}
Chris Lattner4eb445d2007-01-26 01:27:23 +0000850
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000851void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000852 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +0000853 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +0000854 Types.push_back(Ty);
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +0000855}
856
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000857void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
858 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
859 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000860 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000861
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +0000862 this->Target = &Target;
863
864 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
865 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
866
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000867 // C99 6.2.5p19.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000868 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000869
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000870 // C99 6.2.5p2.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000871 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000872 // C99 6.2.5p3.
Eli Friedman9ffd4a92009-06-05 07:05:05 +0000873 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
Chris Lattnerb16f4552007-06-03 07:25:34 +0000874 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
875 else
876 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000877 // C99 6.2.5p4.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000878 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
879 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
880 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
881 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
882 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000883
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000884 // C99 6.2.5p6.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000885 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
886 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
887 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
888 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
889 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000890
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000891 // C99 6.2.5p10.
Chris Lattner726f97b2006-12-03 02:57:32 +0000892 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
893 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
894 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000895
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +0000896 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
897 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
898 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
899
Hans Wennborg0d81e012013-05-10 10:08:40 +0000900 // C++ 3.9.1p5
901 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
902 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
903 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
904 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
905 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
906 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
907 else {
908 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
909 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
910 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +0000911
James Molloy36365542012-05-04 10:55:22 +0000912 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
913
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +0000914 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
915 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
916 else // C99
917 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
918
919 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
920 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
921 else // C99
922 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
923
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +0000924 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
925 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
926 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
927 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
928 // expressions.
929 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000930
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +0000931 // Placeholder type for functions.
932 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
933
John McCall0009fcc2011-04-26 20:42:42 +0000934 // Placeholder type for bound members.
935 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
936
John McCall526ab472011-10-25 17:37:35 +0000937 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
938 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
939
John McCall31996342011-04-07 08:22:57 +0000940 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
941 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
942
John McCall8a6b59a2011-10-17 18:09:15 +0000943 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
944 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
945
Eli Friedman34866c72012-08-31 00:14:07 +0000946 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
947 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
948
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000949 // C99 6.2.5p11.
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +0000950 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
951 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
952 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000953
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +0000954 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +0000955 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
956 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
Fariborz Jahanian252ba5f2009-11-21 19:53:08 +0000957 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +0000958
959 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
960 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
961 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
962 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
963 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
964 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
965 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +0000966
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +0000967 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +0000968 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +0000969 }
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +0000970
971 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
Fariborz Jahanian29898f42012-04-16 21:03:30 +0000972 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
973 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
Ted Kremeneke65b0862012-03-06 20:05:56 +0000974
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +0000975 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +0000976
977 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000978
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +0000979 // void * type
980 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +0000981
982 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
983 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +0000984
985 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
986 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +0000987
988 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
989 VaListTagTy = QualType();
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +0000990}
991
David Blaikie9c902b52011-09-25 23:23:43 +0000992DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisca0d0cd2010-09-22 14:32:24 +0000993 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
994}
995
Douglas Gregor561eceb2010-08-30 16:49:28 +0000996AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
997 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
998 if (!Result) {
999 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1000 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1001 }
1002
1003 return *Result;
1004}
1005
1006/// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1007void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1008 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1009 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1010 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1011 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1012 }
1013}
1014
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001015MemberSpecializationInfo *
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001016ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001017 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
Douglas Gregor3c74d412009-10-14 20:14:33 +00001018 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, MemberSpecializationInfo *>::iterator Pos
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001019 = InstantiatedFromStaticDataMember.find(Var);
1020 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromStaticDataMember.end())
1021 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001022
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001023 return Pos->second;
1024}
1025
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001026void
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001027ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001028 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1029 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001030 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1031 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1032 assert(!InstantiatedFromStaticDataMember[Inst] &&
1033 "Already noted what static data member was instantiated from");
Douglas Gregor86d142a2009-10-08 07:24:58 +00001034 InstantiatedFromStaticDataMember[Inst]
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscdb8b3f2010-07-04 21:44:00 +00001035 = new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00001036}
1037
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001038FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1039 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1040 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1041 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001042 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1043 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001044 return 0;
1045
1046 return Pos->second;
1047}
1048
1049void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1050 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1051 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1052 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00001053 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00001054}
1055
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001056NamedDecl *
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001057ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
John McCalle61f2ba2009-11-18 02:36:19 +00001058 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001059 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1060 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001061 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001062
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001063 return Pos->second;
1064}
1065
1066void
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00001067ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1068 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1069 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1070 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1071 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1072 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1073 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1074}
1075
1076UsingShadowDecl *
1077ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1078 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1079 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1080 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1081 return 0;
1082
1083 return Pos->second;
1084}
1085
1086void
1087ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1088 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1089 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1090 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
Anders Carlsson4bb87ce2009-08-29 19:37:28 +00001091}
1092
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001093FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1094 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1095 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1096 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1097 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001098
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001099 return Pos->second;
1100}
1101
1102void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1103 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1104 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1105 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1106 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1107 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001108
Anders Carlsson5da84842009-09-01 04:26:58 +00001109 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1110}
1111
Fariborz Jahanian595ec5d2011-04-27 17:14:21 +00001112bool ASTContext::ZeroBitfieldFollowsNonBitfield(const FieldDecl *FD,
1113 const FieldDecl *LastFD) const {
1114 return (FD->isBitField() && LastFD && !LastFD->isBitField() &&
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00001115 FD->getBitWidthValue(*this) == 0);
Fariborz Jahanian595ec5d2011-04-27 17:14:21 +00001116}
1117
Fariborz Jahanianeb397412011-05-02 17:20:56 +00001118bool ASTContext::ZeroBitfieldFollowsBitfield(const FieldDecl *FD,
1119 const FieldDecl *LastFD) const {
1120 return (FD->isBitField() && LastFD && LastFD->isBitField() &&
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00001121 FD->getBitWidthValue(*this) == 0 &&
1122 LastFD->getBitWidthValue(*this) != 0);
Fariborz Jahanianeb397412011-05-02 17:20:56 +00001123}
1124
Fariborz Jahanian84335f72011-05-04 18:51:37 +00001125bool ASTContext::BitfieldFollowsBitfield(const FieldDecl *FD,
1126 const FieldDecl *LastFD) const {
1127 return (FD->isBitField() && LastFD && LastFD->isBitField() &&
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00001128 FD->getBitWidthValue(*this) &&
1129 LastFD->getBitWidthValue(*this));
Fariborz Jahanian84335f72011-05-04 18:51:37 +00001130}
1131
Chad Rosierf01a7dd2011-08-04 23:34:15 +00001132bool ASTContext::NonBitfieldFollowsBitfield(const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanianb7a28792011-05-06 21:56:12 +00001133 const FieldDecl *LastFD) const {
1134 return (!FD->isBitField() && LastFD && LastFD->isBitField() &&
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00001135 LastFD->getBitWidthValue(*this));
Fariborz Jahanianb7a28792011-05-06 21:56:12 +00001136}
1137
Chad Rosierf01a7dd2011-08-04 23:34:15 +00001138bool ASTContext::BitfieldFollowsNonBitfield(const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanianb7a28792011-05-06 21:56:12 +00001139 const FieldDecl *LastFD) const {
1140 return (FD->isBitField() && LastFD && !LastFD->isBitField() &&
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00001141 FD->getBitWidthValue(*this));
Fariborz Jahanianb7a28792011-05-06 21:56:12 +00001142}
1143
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001144ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1145ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1146 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001147 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001148 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1149 return 0;
1150
1151 return Pos->second.begin();
1152}
1153
1154ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1155ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1156 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001157 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001158 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1159 return 0;
1160
1161 return Pos->second.end();
1162}
1163
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001164unsigned
1165ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1166 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001167 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6685e8a2010-07-04 21:44:35 +00001168 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1169 return 0;
1170
1171 return Pos->second.size();
1172}
1173
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001174void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1175 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscc4ca0a2012-10-09 01:23:45 +00001176 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
Douglas Gregor832940b2010-03-02 23:58:15 +00001177 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1178}
1179
Dmitri Gribenko941ab0f2012-11-03 14:24:57 +00001180void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1181 const NamedDecl *D,
1182 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001183 assert(D);
1184
1185 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc8e70082013-04-17 00:09:03 +00001186 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1187 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001188 return;
1189 }
1190
1191 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1192 if (!Method)
1193 return;
1194
Argyrios Kyrtzidis353f6a42012-10-09 18:19:01 +00001195 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1196 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisa7a10812012-10-09 20:08:43 +00001197 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9556e62012-10-09 01:23:50 +00001198}
1199
Douglas Gregor0f2a3602011-12-03 00:30:27 +00001200void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1201 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1202 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1203 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1204 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1205 LastLocalImport = Import;
1206 return;
1207 }
1208
1209 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1210 LastLocalImport = Import;
1211}
1212
Chris Lattner53cfe802007-07-18 17:52:12 +00001213//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1214// Type Sizing and Analysis
1215//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001216
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001217/// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1218/// scalar floating point type.
1219const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001220 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001221 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1222 switch (BT->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001223 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001224 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001225 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1226 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1227 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001228 }
1229}
1230
Ken Dyck160146e2010-01-27 17:10:57 +00001231/// getDeclAlign - Return a conservative estimate of the alignment of the
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001232/// specified decl. Note that bitfields do not have a valid alignment, so
1233/// this method will assert on them.
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001234/// If @p RefAsPointee, references are treated like their underlying type
1235/// (for alignof), else they're treated like pointers (for CodeGen).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001236CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool RefAsPointee) const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001237 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001238
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001239 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1240 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1241 Align = AlignFromAttr;
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001242
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001243 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1244 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1245 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1246 //
Peter Collingbourne2f3cf4b2011-09-29 18:04:28 +00001247 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001248 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1249 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1250 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1251 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1252 } else {
1253 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1254 }
1255 }
Fariborz Jahanian9f107182011-05-05 21:19:14 +00001256 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1257 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1258 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1259 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001260
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001261 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1262 // else about the declaration and its type.
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001263 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001264 // do nothing
1265
John McCall94268702010-10-08 18:24:19 +00001266 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001267 QualType T = VD->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001268 if (const ReferenceType* RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001269 if (RefAsPointee)
1270 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1271 else
1272 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1273 }
1274 if (!T->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001275 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1276 // large-array alignment on the target.
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001277 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001278 const ArrayType *arrayType;
1279 if (MinWidth && (arrayType = getAsArrayType(T))) {
1280 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001281 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001282 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1283 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001284 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001285
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001286 // Walk through any array types while we're at it.
1287 T = getBaseElementType(arrayType);
1288 }
Chad Rosier99ee7822011-07-26 07:03:04 +00001289 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001290 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1291 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage())
1292 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1293 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001294 }
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001295
1296 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1297 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1298 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1299 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1300 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
1301 if (const FieldDecl *field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1302 // So calculate the alignment of the field.
1303 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(field->getParent());
1304
1305 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001306 unsigned fieldAlign = toBits(layout.getAlignment());
John McCall4e819612011-01-20 07:57:12 +00001307
1308 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1309 uint64_t offset = layout.getFieldOffset(field->getFieldIndex());
1310 if (offset > 0) {
1311 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1312 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1313 uint64_t lowBitOfOffset = offset & (~offset + 1);
1314 if (lowBitOfOffset < fieldAlign)
1315 fieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(lowBitOfOffset);
1316 }
1317
1318 Align = std::min(Align, fieldAlign);
Charles Davis3fc51072010-02-23 04:52:00 +00001319 }
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001320 }
Eli Friedman19a546c2009-02-22 02:56:25 +00001321
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001322 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
Chris Lattner68061312009-01-24 21:53:27 +00001323}
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001324
John McCallf1249922012-08-21 04:10:00 +00001325// getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1326// chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1327// the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1328// using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1329std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1330ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1331 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1332
1333 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1334 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1335 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1336 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1337 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1338 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1339 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1340 }
1341 }
1342
1343 return sizeAndAlign;
1344}
1345
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001346std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001347ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001348 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfo(T);
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001349 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.first),
1350 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.second));
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001351}
1352
1353std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
Ken Dyckd24099d2011-02-20 01:55:18 +00001354ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001355 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1356}
1357
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001358std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1359 TypeInfoMap::iterator it = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1360 if (it != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1361 return it->second;
1362
1363 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1364 MemoizedTypeInfo.insert(std::make_pair(T, Info));
1365 return Info;
1366}
1367
1368/// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1369/// method does not work on incomplete types.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001370///
1371/// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1372/// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1373/// should take a QualType, &c.
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001374std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned>
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001375ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
Mike Stump5b9a3d52009-02-27 18:32:39 +00001376 uint64_t Width=0;
1377 unsigned Align=8;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001378 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001379#define TYPE(Class, Base)
1380#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001381#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001382#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
1383#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
John McCall15547bb2011-06-28 16:49:23 +00001384 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001385
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001386 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1387 case Type::FunctionProto:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001388 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1389 Width = 0;
1390 Align = 32;
1391 break;
1392
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001393 case Type::IncompleteArray:
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001394 case Type::VariableArray:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001395 Width = 0;
1396 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1397 break;
1398
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00001399 case Type::ConstantArray: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001400 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001401
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001402 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001403 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
Daniel Dunbarc6475872012-03-09 04:12:54 +00001404 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.first <= (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1405 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
Abramo Bagnarad541a4c2011-12-13 11:23:52 +00001406 Width = EltInfo.first*Size;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001407 Align = EltInfo.second;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisae40e4e2011-04-26 21:05:39 +00001408 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001409 break;
Christopher Lambc5fafa22007-12-29 05:10:55 +00001410 }
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00001411 case Type::ExtVector:
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001412 case Type::Vector: {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001413 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1414 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1415 Width = EltInfo.first*VT->getNumElements();
Eli Friedman3df5efe2008-05-30 09:31:38 +00001416 Align = Width;
Nate Begemanb699c9b2009-01-18 06:42:49 +00001417 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1418 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
Dan Gohmanef78c8e2010-04-21 23:32:43 +00001419 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001420 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1421 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1422 }
Chad Rosiercc40ea72012-07-13 23:57:43 +00001423 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1424 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1425 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1426 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
Chris Lattnerf2e101f2007-07-19 22:06:24 +00001427 break;
1428 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001429
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001430 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001431 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00001432 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
Chris Lattner4481b422007-07-14 01:29:45 +00001433 case BuiltinType::Void:
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001434 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1435 Width = 0;
1436 Align = 8;
1437 break;
1438
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001439 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001440 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1441 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001442 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001443 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1444 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1445 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001446 case BuiltinType::SChar:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001447 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1448 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001449 break;
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00001450 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1451 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001452 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1453 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00001454 break;
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001455 case BuiltinType::Char16:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001456 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1457 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001458 break;
1459 case BuiltinType::Char32:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001460 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1461 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00001462 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001463 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001464 case BuiltinType::Short:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001465 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1466 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001467 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001468 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001469 case BuiltinType::Int:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001470 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1471 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001472 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001473 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001474 case BuiltinType::Long:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001475 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1476 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001477 break;
Chris Lattner355332d2007-07-13 22:27:08 +00001478 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001479 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001480 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1481 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001482 break;
Chris Lattner0a415ec2009-04-30 02:55:13 +00001483 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1484 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1485 Width = 128;
1486 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1487 break;
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00001488 case BuiltinType::Half:
1489 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1490 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1491 break;
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001492 case BuiltinType::Float:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001493 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1494 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001495 break;
1496 case BuiltinType::Double:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001497 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1498 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001499 break;
1500 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001501 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1502 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001503 break;
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001504 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001505 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1506 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
Sebastian Redla81b0b72009-05-27 19:34:06 +00001507 break;
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001508 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1509 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1510 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001511 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1512 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Fariborz Jahanian9c6a39e2010-08-02 18:03:20 +00001513 break;
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00001514 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1515 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1516 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1517 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1518 break;
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00001519 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyeid8a08ea2012-12-18 14:38:23 +00001520 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1521 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1522 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1523 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1524 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1525 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1526 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1527 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1528 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1529 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001530 }
Chris Lattner48f84b82007-07-15 23:46:53 +00001531 break;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00001532 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001533 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1534 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
Chris Lattner6a4f7452007-12-19 19:23:28 +00001535 break;
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001536 case Type::BlockPointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001537 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1538 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001539 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1540 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Steve Naroff921a45c2008-09-24 15:05:44 +00001541 break;
1542 }
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001543 case Type::LValueReference:
1544 case Type::RValueReference: {
1545 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1546 // the pointer route.
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001547 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1548 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001549 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1550 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00001551 break;
1552 }
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001553 case Type::Pointer: {
Peter Collingbourne599cb8e2011-03-18 22:38:29 +00001554 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00001555 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1556 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
Chris Lattner2dca6ff2008-03-08 08:34:58 +00001557 break;
1558 }
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001559 case Type::MemberPointer: {
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00001560 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
Reid Kleckner3a52abf2013-03-28 20:02:56 +00001561 llvm::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
Anders Carlsson32440a02009-05-17 02:06:04 +00001562 break;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00001563 }
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001564 case Type::Complex: {
1565 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1566 // size.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001567 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> EltInfo =
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00001568 getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001569 Width = EltInfo.first*2;
Chris Lattner647fb222007-07-18 18:26:58 +00001570 Align = EltInfo.second;
1571 break;
1572 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001573 case Type::ObjCObject:
1574 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001575 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001576 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001577 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001578 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001579 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Devang Pateldbb72632008-06-04 21:54:36 +00001580 break;
1581 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001582 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001583 case Type::Enum: {
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001584 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1585
1586 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
Douglas Gregor7f971892011-04-20 17:29:44 +00001587 Width = 8;
1588 Align = 8;
Chris Lattner572100b2008-08-09 21:35:13 +00001589 break;
1590 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001591
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001592 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT))
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001593 return getTypeInfo(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType());
1594
Daniel Dunbarbbc0af72008-11-08 05:48:37 +00001595 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001596 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001597 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
Ken Dyck7ad11e72011-02-15 02:32:40 +00001598 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
Chris Lattner49a953a2007-07-23 22:46:22 +00001599 break;
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001600 }
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001601
Chris Lattner63d2b362009-10-22 05:17:15 +00001602 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001603 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1604 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00001605
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001606 case Type::Auto: {
1607 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00001608 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1609 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
Matt Beaumont-Gay7a24210e2011-02-22 20:00:16 +00001610 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00001611 }
1612
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00001613 case Type::Paren:
1614 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1615
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001616 case Type::Typedef: {
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00001617 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001618 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1619 = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
Chris Lattner29eb47b2011-02-19 22:55:41 +00001620 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1621 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1622 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1623 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment())
1624 Align = AttrAlign;
1625 else
1626 Align = Info.second;
Douglas Gregorf5bae222010-08-27 00:11:28 +00001627 Width = Info.first;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00001628 break;
Chris Lattner8b23c252008-04-06 22:05:18 +00001629 }
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001630
1631 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
1632 return getTypeInfo(cast<TypeOfExprType>(T)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType()
1633 .getTypePtr());
1634
1635 case Type::TypeOf:
1636 return getTypeInfo(cast<TypeOfType>(T)->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
1637
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00001638 case Type::Decltype:
1639 return getTypeInfo(cast<DecltypeType>(T)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType()
1640 .getTypePtr());
1641
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00001642 case Type::UnaryTransform:
1643 return getTypeInfo(cast<UnaryTransformType>(T)->getUnderlyingType());
1644
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00001645 case Type::Elaborated:
1646 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001647
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00001648 case Type::Attributed:
1649 return getTypeInfo(
1650 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1651
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00001652 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001653 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != T &&
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001654 "Cannot request the size of a dependent type");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00001655 const TemplateSpecializationType *TST = cast<TemplateSpecializationType>(T);
1656 // A type alias template specialization may refer to a typedef with the
1657 // aligned attribute on it.
1658 if (TST->isTypeAlias())
1659 return getTypeInfo(TST->getAliasedType().getTypePtr());
1660 else
1661 return getTypeInfo(getCanonicalType(T));
1662 }
1663
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001664 case Type::Atomic: {
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001665 // Start with the base type information.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001666 std::pair<uint64_t, unsigned> Info
1667 = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1668 Width = Info.first;
1669 Align = Info.second;
John McCalla8ec7eb2013-03-07 21:37:17 +00001670
1671 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1672 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1673 // favorable to atomic operations:
1674 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1675 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1676 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1677 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1678
1679 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001680 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1681 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00001682 }
1683
Douglas Gregoref462e62009-04-30 17:32:17 +00001684 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001685
Eli Friedman4b72fdd2011-10-14 20:59:01 +00001686 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001687 return std::make_pair(Width, Align);
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001688}
1689
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001690/// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1691CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1692 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1693}
1694
Ken Dyckb0fcc592011-02-11 01:54:29 +00001695/// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1696int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1697 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1698}
1699
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001700/// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1701/// This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001702CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001703 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeSize(T));
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001704}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001705CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001706 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeSize(T));
Ken Dyck8c89d592009-12-22 14:23:30 +00001707}
1708
Ken Dycka6046ab2010-01-26 17:25:18 +00001709/// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001710/// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001711CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001712 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001713}
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001714CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
Ken Dyckcc56c542011-01-15 18:38:59 +00001715 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
Ken Dyck24d28d62010-01-26 17:22:55 +00001716}
1717
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001718/// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1719/// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1720/// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1721/// a data type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001722unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001723 unsigned ABIAlign = getTypeAlign(T);
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001724
1725 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001726 if (const ComplexType* CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001727 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1728 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
Chad Rosierb57321a2012-03-21 20:20:47 +00001729 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1730 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
Eli Friedman7ab09572009-05-25 21:27:19 +00001731 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
1732
Chris Lattnera3402cd2009-01-27 18:08:34 +00001733 return ABIAlign;
1734}
1735
Ulrich Weigandfa806422013-05-06 16:23:57 +00001736/// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1737/// to a global variable of the specified type.
1738unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1739 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1740}
1741
1742/// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1743/// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1744CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1745 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1746}
1747
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001748/// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1749/// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1750/// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1751/// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1752/// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001753///
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001754void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1755 bool leafClass,
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001756 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00001757 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1758 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1759 if (!leafClass) {
1760 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::ivar_iterator I = OI->ivar_begin(),
1761 E = OI->ivar_end(); I != E; ++I)
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00001762 Ivars.push_back(*I);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00001763 } else {
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001764 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00001765 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
Fariborz Jahanianb26d5782011-06-28 18:05:25 +00001766 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1767 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1768 }
Fariborz Jahanian0f44d812009-05-12 18:14:29 +00001769}
1770
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001771/// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1772/// those inherited by it.
1773void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00001774 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001775 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001776 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1777 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
1778 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::all_protocol_iterator P = OI->all_referenced_protocol_begin(),
1779 PE = OI->all_referenced_protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001780 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001781 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001782 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001783 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001784 Protocols.insert((*P)->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001785 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1786 }
Fariborz Jahanian8e3b9db2010-02-25 18:24:33 +00001787 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001788
1789 // Categories of this Interface.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001790 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::visible_categories_iterator
1791 Cat = OI->visible_categories_begin(),
1792 CatEnd = OI->visible_categories_end();
1793 Cat != CatEnd; ++Cat) {
1794 CollectInheritedProtocols(*Cat, Protocols);
1795 }
1796
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001797 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1798 while (SD) {
1799 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1800 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1801 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001802 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
Ted Kremenek0ef508d2010-09-01 01:21:15 +00001803 for (ObjCCategoryDecl::protocol_iterator P = OC->protocol_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001804 PE = OC->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1805 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001806 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001807 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1808 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1809 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1810 }
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001811 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001812 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = OP->protocol_begin(),
1813 PE = OP->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P) {
1814 ObjCProtocolDecl *Proto = (*P);
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00001815 Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001816 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator P = Proto->protocol_begin(),
1817 PE = Proto->protocol_end(); P != PE; ++P)
1818 CollectInheritedProtocols(*P, Protocols);
1819 }
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00001820 }
1821}
1822
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001823unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001824 unsigned count = 0;
1825 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
Douglas Gregor048fbfa2013-01-16 23:00:23 +00001826 for (ObjCInterfaceDecl::known_extensions_iterator
1827 Ext = OI->known_extensions_begin(),
1828 ExtEnd = OI->known_extensions_end();
1829 Ext != ExtEnd; ++Ext) {
1830 count += Ext->ivar_size();
1831 }
1832
Fariborz Jahaniand2ae2d02010-03-22 18:25:57 +00001833 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1834 // includes synthesized ivars.
1835 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
Benjamin Kramer0a3fe042010-04-27 17:47:25 +00001836 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1837
Fariborz Jahanian7c809592009-06-04 01:19:09 +00001838 return count;
1839}
1840
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2e809ce2012-02-03 05:58:16 +00001841bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1842 if (!E)
1843 return false;
1844
1845 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1846 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1847
1848 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1849 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1850 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1851 return true;
1852
1853 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1854 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1855
1856 return false;
1857}
1858
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6d9fab72009-07-21 00:05:53 +00001859/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1860ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1861 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1862 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1863 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1864 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
1865 return 0;
1866}
1867/// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1868ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1869 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1870 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1871 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1872 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
1873 return 0;
1874}
1875
1876/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1877void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1878 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1879 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1880 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1881}
1882/// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1883void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1884 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1885 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1886 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1887}
1888
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001889const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1890 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1891 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1892 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001893 return ID;
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001894 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1895 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001896 return CD->getClassInterface();
Dmitri Gribenko37527c22013-02-03 13:23:21 +00001897 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1898 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb9689bb2011-11-01 17:14:12 +00001899 return IMD->getClassInterface();
1900
1901 return 0;
1902}
1903
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001904/// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1905/// none exists.
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001906Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001907 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1908 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1909 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian50198092010-12-02 17:02:11 +00001910 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001911 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001912 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : 0;
1913}
1914
1915/// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1916void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1917 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
Fariborz Jahanian1321cbb2010-12-06 17:28:17 +00001918 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1919 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
Fariborz Jahanian7cfe7672010-12-01 22:29:46 +00001920 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1921}
1922
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001923TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001924 unsigned DataSize) const {
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001925 if (!DataSize)
1926 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
1927 else
1928 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001929 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
John McCall26fe7e02009-10-21 00:23:54 +00001930
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001931 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
1932 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
1933 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
1934 return TInfo;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis3f79ad72009-08-19 01:27:32 +00001935}
1936
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001937TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
Douglas Gregor0231d8d2011-01-19 20:10:05 +00001938 SourceLocation L) const {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00001939 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
Douglas Gregor2d525f02011-01-25 19:13:18 +00001940 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
John McCall3665e002009-10-23 21:14:09 +00001941 return DI;
1942}
1943
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001944const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001945ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001946 return getObjCLayout(D, 0);
1947}
1948
1949const ASTRecordLayout &
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001950ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
1951 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
Daniel Dunbar02f7f5f2009-05-03 10:38:35 +00001952 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
1953}
1954
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00001955//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1956// Type creation/memoization methods
1957//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1958
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001959QualType
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001960ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
1961 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
1962 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001963
1964 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
1965 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001966 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
1967 void *insertPos = 0;
1968 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
1969 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
1970 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001971 }
1972
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001973 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
1974 QualType canon;
1975 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
1976 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00001977 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
1978 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00001979
1980 // Re-find the insert position.
1981 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
1982 }
1983
1984 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
1985 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
1986 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001987}
1988
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00001989QualType
1990ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00001991 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
1992 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
Chris Lattner445fcab2008-02-20 20:55:12 +00001993 return T;
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00001994
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001995 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
1996 // into one ExtQuals node.
1997 QualifierCollector Quals;
1998 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001999
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002000 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2001 // another one.
2002 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2003 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2004 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002005
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002006 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Christopher Lamb025b5fb2008-02-04 02:31:56 +00002007}
2008
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002009QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002010 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002011 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00002012 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002013 return T;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002014
John McCall53fa7142010-12-24 02:08:15 +00002015 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2016 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00002017 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb68215c2009-06-03 17:15:17 +00002018 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2019 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2020 }
2021 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002022
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002023 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2024 // into one ExtQuals node.
2025 QualifierCollector Quals;
2026 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002027
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002028 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2029 // another one.
2030 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2031 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2032 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002033
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002034 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9342009-02-18 05:09:49 +00002035}
Chris Lattner983a8bb2007-07-13 22:13:22 +00002036
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002037const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2038 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2039 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2040 return T;
2041
2042 QualType Result;
2043 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
2044 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getResultType(), Info);
2045 } else {
2046 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2047 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2048 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002049 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getResultType(),
2050 ArrayRef<QualType>(FPT->arg_type_begin(),
2051 FPT->getNumArgs()),
2052 EPI);
John McCall4f5019e2010-12-19 02:44:49 +00002053 }
2054
2055 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2056}
2057
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002058void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2059 QualType ResultType) {
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002060 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2061 while (true) {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002062 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2063 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2064 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getArgTypes(), EPI));
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002065 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2066 FD = Next;
2067 else
2068 break;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002069 }
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00002070 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2071 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00002072}
2073
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002074/// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2075/// number with the specified element type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002076QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002077 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2078 // structure.
2079 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2080 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002081
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002082 void *InsertPos = 0;
2083 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2084 return QualType(CT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002085
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002086 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2087 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2088 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002089 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002090 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002091
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002092 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2093 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002094 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002095 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002096 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00002097 Types.push_back(New);
2098 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2099 return QualType(New, 0);
2100}
2101
Chris Lattner970e54e2006-11-12 00:37:36 +00002102/// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2103/// the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002104QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattnerd5973eb2006-11-12 00:53:46 +00002105 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2106 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002107 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002108 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002109
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002110 void *InsertPos = 0;
2111 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002112 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002113
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002114 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2115 // so fill in the canonical type field.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002116 QualType Canonical;
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002117 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00002118 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002119
Bob Wilsonc8541f22013-03-15 17:12:43 +00002120 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2121 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2122 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2123 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002124 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
Chris Lattner67521df2007-01-27 01:29:36 +00002125 Types.push_back(New);
2126 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002127 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerddc135e2006-11-10 06:34:16 +00002128}
2129
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002130/// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002131/// a pointer to the specified block.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002132QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
Steve Naroff0ac012832008-08-28 19:20:44 +00002133 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2134 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002135 // structure.
2136 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2137 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002138
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002139 void *InsertPos = 0;
2140 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2141 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2142 return QualType(PT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143
2144 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002145 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2146 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002147 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002148 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002149
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002150 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2151 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2152 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002153 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002154 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002155 BlockPointerType *New
2156 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
Steve Naroffec33ed92008-08-27 16:04:49 +00002157 Types.push_back(New);
2158 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2159 return QualType(New, 0);
2160}
2161
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002162/// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2163/// lvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002164QualType
2165ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
Douglas Gregor291e8ee2011-05-21 22:16:50 +00002166 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2167 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2168
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002169 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2170 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002171 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002172 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002173
2174 void *InsertPos = 0;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002175 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2176 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002177 return QualType(RT, 0);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002178
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002179 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2180
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002181 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2182 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2183 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002184 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2185 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2186 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002187
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002188 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002189 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2190 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002191 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002192 }
2193
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002194 LValueReferenceType *New
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002195 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2196 SpelledAsLValue);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002197 Types.push_back(New);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002198 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002199
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002200 return QualType(New, 0);
2201}
2202
2203/// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2204/// rvalue reference to the specified type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002205QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002206 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2207 // structure.
2208 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002209 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002210
2211 void *InsertPos = 0;
2212 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2213 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2214 return QualType(RT, 0);
2215
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002216 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2217
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002218 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2219 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2220 QualType Canonical;
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002221 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2222 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2223 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002224
2225 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2226 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2227 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002228 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002229 }
2230
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002231 RValueReferenceType *New
2232 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00002233 Types.push_back(New);
2234 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Bill Wendling3708c182007-05-27 10:15:43 +00002235 return QualType(New, 0);
2236}
2237
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002238/// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2239/// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002240QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002241 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2242 // structure.
2243 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2244 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2245
2246 void *InsertPos = 0;
2247 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2248 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2249 return QualType(PT, 0);
2250
2251 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2252 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2253 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor615ac672009-11-04 16:49:01 +00002254 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002255 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2256
2257 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2258 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2259 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002260 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002261 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002262 MemberPointerType *New
2263 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
Sebastian Redl9ed6efd2009-01-24 21:16:55 +00002264 Types.push_back(New);
2265 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2266 return QualType(New, 0);
2267}
2268
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002269/// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002270/// array of the specified element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002271QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002272 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002273 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002274 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
Sebastian Redl2dfdb822009-11-05 15:52:31 +00002275 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2276 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
Eli Friedmanbe7e42b2009-05-29 20:17:55 +00002277 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2278
Chris Lattnere2df3f92009-05-13 04:12:56 +00002279 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2280 // the target.
2281 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
Jay Foad6d4db0c2010-12-07 08:25:34 +00002282 ArySize =
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00002283 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002284
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002285 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002286 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002287
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002288 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002289 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002290 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002291 return QualType(ATP, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002292
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002293 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2294 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2295 QualType Canon;
2296 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2297 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002298 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002299 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002300 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002301
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002302 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002303 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002304 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002305 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002306 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002307
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002308 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002309 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00002310 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner36f8e652007-01-27 08:31:04 +00002311 Types.push_back(New);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002312 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattner7ccecb92006-11-12 08:50:50 +00002313}
2314
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002315/// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2316/// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2317/// sizes replaced with [*].
2318QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2319 // Vastly most common case.
2320 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002321
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002322 QualType result;
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002323
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002324 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002325 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002326 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2327#define TYPE(Class, Base)
2328#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2329#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2330#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2331 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2332
2333 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2334 case Type::Builtin:
2335 case Type::Complex:
2336 case Type::Vector:
2337 case Type::ExtVector:
2338 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2339 case Type::ObjCObject:
2340 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2341 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2342 case Type::Record:
2343 case Type::Enum:
2344 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2345 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2346 case Type::TypeOf:
2347 case Type::Decltype:
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00002348 case Type::UnaryTransform:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002349 case Type::DependentName:
2350 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2351 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2352 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2353 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2354 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00002355 case Type::Auto:
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002356 case Type::PackExpansion:
2357 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2358
2359 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2360 // further decay.
2361 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2362 case Type::FunctionProto:
2363 case Type::BlockPointer:
2364 case Type::MemberPointer:
2365 return type;
2366
2367 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2368 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2369 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2370 // optimizations available here.
2371 case Type::Pointer:
2372 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2373 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2374 break;
2375
2376 case Type::LValueReference: {
2377 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2378 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2379 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2380 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2381 break;
2382 }
2383
2384 case Type::RValueReference: {
2385 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2386 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2387 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2388 break;
2389 }
2390
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00002391 case Type::Atomic: {
2392 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2393 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2394 break;
2395 }
2396
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002397 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2398 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2399 result = getConstantArrayType(
2400 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2401 cat->getSize(),
2402 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2403 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2404 break;
2405 }
2406
2407 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2408 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2409 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2410 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2411 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2412 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2413 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2414 dat->getBracketsRange());
2415 break;
2416 }
2417
2418 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2419 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2420 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2421 result = getVariableArrayType(
2422 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
2423 /*size*/ 0,
2424 ArrayType::Normal,
2425 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2426 SourceRange());
2427 break;
2428 }
2429
2430 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2431 case Type::VariableArray: {
2432 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2433 result = getVariableArrayType(
2434 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
2435 /*size*/ 0,
2436 ArrayType::Star,
2437 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2438 vat->getBracketsRange());
2439 break;
2440 }
2441 }
2442
2443 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002444 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
John McCall06549462011-01-18 08:40:38 +00002445}
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00002446
Steve Naroffcadebd02007-08-30 18:14:25 +00002447/// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2448/// variable array of the specified element type.
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00002449QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2450 Expr *NumElts,
Steve Naroff90dfdd52007-08-30 18:10:14 +00002451 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002452 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002453 SourceRange Brackets) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002454 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2455 // that have an expression provided for their size.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002456 QualType Canon;
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002457
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002458 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2459 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2460 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002461 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002462 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002463 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Douglas Gregor5e8c8c02010-05-23 16:10:32 +00002464 }
2465
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002466 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
Abramo Bagnara92141d22011-01-27 19:55:10 +00002467 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002468
2469 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2470 Types.push_back(New);
2471 return QualType(New, 0);
2472}
2473
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002474/// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2475/// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
Douglas Gregorf3f95522009-07-31 00:23:35 +00002476/// type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002477QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2478 Expr *numElements,
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002479 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002480 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2481 SourceRange brackets) const {
2482 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2483 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002484 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2485
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002486 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2487 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2488 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2489 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2490 if (!numElements) {
2491 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2492 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2493 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2494 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2495 brackets);
2496 Types.push_back(newType);
2497 return QualType(newType, 0);
2498 }
2499
2500 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2501 // also build a canonical type.
2502
2503 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2504
2505 void *insertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002506 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002507 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002508 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002509 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002510
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002511 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2512 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2513 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002514
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002515 // If we don't have one, build one.
2516 if (!canonTy) {
2517 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002518 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002519 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2520 brackets);
2521 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2522 Types.push_back(canonTy);
Douglas Gregorad2956c2009-11-19 18:03:26 +00002523 }
2524
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002525 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2526 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002527 canonElementType.Quals);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002528
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002529 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2530 // then just use that as our result.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002531 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002532 return canon;
2533
2534 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2535 // of the element type.
2536 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2537 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2538 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2539 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2540 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2541 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002542}
2543
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002544QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002545 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002546 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002547 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002548 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002549
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002550 void *insertPos = 0;
2551 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2552 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2553 return QualType(iat, 0);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002554
2555 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002556 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2557 // qualifiers off the element type.
2558 QualType canon;
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002559
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002560 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2561 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002562 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002563 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00002564 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002565
2566 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002567 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2568 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2569 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
Ted Kremenek843ebedd2007-10-29 23:37:31 +00002570 }
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002571
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002572 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2573 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
Eli Friedmanbd258282008-02-15 18:16:39 +00002574
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002575 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2576 Types.push_back(newType);
2577 return QualType(newType, 0);
Steve Naroff5c131802007-08-30 01:06:46 +00002578}
2579
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002580/// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2581/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
John Thompson22334602010-02-05 00:12:22 +00002582QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002583 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00002584 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002585
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002586 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2587 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002588 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002589
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002590 void *InsertPos = 0;
2591 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2592 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2593
2594 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2595 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2596 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00002597 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Bob Wilson77954802010-11-16 00:32:20 +00002598 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002599
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002600 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2601 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002602 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002603 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002604 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002605 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
Steve Naroff4ae0ac62007-07-06 23:09:18 +00002606 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2607 Types.push_back(New);
2608 return QualType(New, 0);
2609}
2610
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002611/// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002612/// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002613QualType
2614ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
Douglas Gregor39c02722011-06-15 16:02:29 +00002615 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002616
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002617 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2618 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00002619 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00002620 VectorType::GenericVector);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002621 void *InsertPos = 0;
2622 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2623 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2624
2625 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2626 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2627 QualType Canonical;
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002628 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002629 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002630
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002631 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2632 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002633 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002634 }
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002635 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2636 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
Steve Naroff91fcddb2007-07-18 18:00:27 +00002637 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2638 Types.push_back(New);
2639 return QualType(New, 0);
2640}
2641
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002642QualType
2643ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2644 Expr *SizeExpr,
2645 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002646 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002647 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002648 SizeExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002649
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002650 void *InsertPos = 0;
2651 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2652 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2653 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2654 if (Canon) {
2655 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2656 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002657 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2658 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2659 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002660 } else {
2661 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2662 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002663 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2664 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2665 AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00002666
2667 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2668 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2669 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2670 (void)CanonCheck;
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002671 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2672 } else {
2673 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2674 SourceLocation());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002675 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2676 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
Douglas Gregor352169a2009-07-31 03:54:25 +00002677 }
2678 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002679
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00002680 Types.push_back(New);
2681 return QualType(New, 0);
2682}
2683
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002684/// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002685///
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002686QualType
2687ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2688 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002689 const CallingConv DefaultCC = Info.getCC();
2690 const CallingConv CallConv = (LangOpts.MRTD && DefaultCC == CC_Default) ?
2691 CC_X86StdCall : DefaultCC;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002692 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2693 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002694 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002695 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002696
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002697 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002698 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002699 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002700 return QualType(FT, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002701
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002702 QualType Canonical;
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00002703 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical() ||
John McCallab26cfa2010-02-05 21:31:56 +00002704 getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv) != CallConv) {
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00002705 Canonical =
2706 getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy),
2707 Info.withCallingConv(getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv)));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002708
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002709 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002710 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2711 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002712 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002713 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002714
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002715 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002716 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002717 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
Chris Lattner47955de2007-01-27 08:37:20 +00002718 Types.push_back(New);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002719 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002720 return QualType(New, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002721}
2722
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002723/// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2724static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2725 return T.isCanonical() &&
2726 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2727 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2728}
2729
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002730/// getFunctionType - Return a normal function type with a typed argument
2731/// list. isVariadic indicates whether the argument list includes '...'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002732QualType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002733ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002734 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002735 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2736
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002737 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2738 // structure.
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00002739 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002740 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2741 *this);
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002742
2743 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002744 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002745 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002746 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002747
2748 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002749 bool isCanonical =
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002750 EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002751 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002752 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002753 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002754 isCanonical = false;
2755
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002756 const CallingConv DefaultCC = EPI.ExtInfo.getCC();
2757 const CallingConv CallConv = (LangOpts.MRTD && DefaultCC == CC_Default) ?
2758 CC_X86StdCall : DefaultCC;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002759
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002760 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002761 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002762 QualType Canonical;
John McCallab26cfa2010-02-05 21:31:56 +00002763 if (!isCanonical || getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv) != CallConv) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00002764 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002765 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2766 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00002767 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002768
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002769 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
Richard Smith5e580292012-02-10 09:58:53 +00002770 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
Sebastian Redl7c6c9e92011-03-06 10:52:04 +00002771 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpecType = EST_None;
2772 CanonicalEPI.NumExceptions = 0;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002773 CanonicalEPI.ExtInfo
2774 = CanonicalEPI.ExtInfo.withCallingConv(getCanonicalCallConv(CallConv));
2775
Douglas Gregorcd780372013-01-17 23:36:45 +00002776 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2777 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2778 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2779 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2780 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2781 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2782 }
2783
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002784 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002785
Chris Lattnerfd4de792007-01-27 01:15:32 +00002786 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002787 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2788 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Jeffrey Yasskinb3321532010-12-23 01:01:28 +00002789 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002790 }
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00002791
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002792 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2793 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2794 // - parameter types
2795 // - exception types
2796 // - consumed-arguments flags
2797 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002798 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2799 // specification.
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002800 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002801 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002802 if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Dynamic) {
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002803 Size += EPI.NumExceptions * sizeof(QualType);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002804 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
Sebastian Redl31ad7542011-03-13 17:09:40 +00002805 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
Richard Smithf623c962012-04-17 00:58:00 +00002806 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Uninstantiated) {
Richard Smithd3729422012-04-19 00:08:28 +00002807 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Richard Smithd3b5c9082012-07-27 04:22:15 +00002808 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpecType == EST_Unevaluated) {
2809 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
Sebastian Redlfa453cf2011-03-12 11:50:43 +00002810 }
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00002811 if (EPI.ConsumedArguments)
2812 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2813
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00002814 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
Roman Divacky65b88cd2011-03-01 17:40:53 +00002815 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
2816 newEPI.ExtInfo = EPI.ExtInfo.withCallingConv(CallConv);
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00002817 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002818 Types.push_back(FTP);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00002819 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002820 return QualType(FTP, 0);
Chris Lattnerc6ad8132006-12-02 07:52:18 +00002821}
Chris Lattneref51c202006-11-10 07:17:23 +00002822
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002823#ifndef NDEBUG
2824static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
2825 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
2826 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
2827 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2828 return true;
2829 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
2830 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
2831 return true;
2832 return false;
2833}
2834#endif
2835
2836/// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
2837/// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
2838QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002839 QualType TST) const {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002840 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
2841 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
2842 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002843 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002844 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
2845 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
2846 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
2847 } else {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002848 Type *newType =
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00002849 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002850 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2851 Types.push_back(newType);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00002852 }
2853 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2854}
2855
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002856/// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
2857/// specified type declaration.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002858QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis89656d22008-10-16 16:50:47 +00002859 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002860 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002861
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002862 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002863 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002864
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002865 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
2866 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
2867
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002868 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002869 assert(!Record->getPreviousDecl() &&
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002870 "struct/union has previous declaration");
2871 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002872 return getRecordType(Record);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002873 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002874 assert(!Enum->getPreviousDecl() &&
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002875 "enum has previous declaration");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002876 return getEnumType(Enum);
John McCall81e38502010-02-16 03:57:14 +00002877 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
John McCallb96ec562009-12-04 22:46:56 +00002878 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002879 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
2880 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2881 Types.push_back(newType);
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00002882 } else
John McCall96f0b5f2010-03-10 06:48:02 +00002883 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002884
Argyrios Kyrtzidisfaf08762008-08-07 20:55:28 +00002885 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Douglas Gregor83a586e2008-04-13 21:07:44 +00002886}
2887
Chris Lattner32d920b2007-01-26 02:01:53 +00002888/// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002889/// specified typedef name decl.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002890QualType
Richard Smithdda56e42011-04-15 14:24:37 +00002891ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2892 QualType Canonical) const {
Steve Naroffe5aa9be2007-04-05 22:36:20 +00002893 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002894
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00002895 if (Canonical.isNull())
2896 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002897 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00002898 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002899 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2900 Types.push_back(newType);
2901 return QualType(newType, 0);
Chris Lattnerd0342e52006-11-20 04:02:15 +00002902}
2903
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002904QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002905 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2906
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002907 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002908 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2909 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2910
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002911 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
2912 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2913 Types.push_back(newType);
2914 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002915}
2916
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002917QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002918 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2919
Douglas Gregorec9fd132012-01-14 16:38:05 +00002920 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002921 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
2922 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
2923
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00002924 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
2925 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
2926 Types.push_back(newType);
2927 return QualType(newType, 0);
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb5fcdc22010-07-04 21:44:47 +00002928}
2929
John McCall81904512011-01-06 01:58:22 +00002930QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
2931 QualType modifiedType,
2932 QualType equivalentType) {
2933 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
2934 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
2935
2936 void *insertPos = 0;
2937 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
2938 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
2939
2940 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
2941 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2942 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
2943
2944 Types.push_back(type);
2945 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
2946
2947 return QualType(type, 0);
2948}
2949
2950
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00002951/// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
2952QualType
2953ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00002954 QualType Replacement) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00002955 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
John McCallcebee162009-10-18 09:09:24 +00002956 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
2957
2958 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2959 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
2960 void *InsertPos = 0;
2961 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
2962 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2963
2964 if (!SubstParm) {
2965 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2966 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
2967 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
2968 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
2969 }
2970
2971 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
2972}
2973
Douglas Gregorada4b792011-01-14 02:55:32 +00002974/// \brief Retrieve a
2975QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
2976 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
2977 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
2978#ifndef NDEBUG
2979 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator P = ArgPack.pack_begin(),
2980 PEnd = ArgPack.pack_end();
2981 P != PEnd; ++P) {
2982 assert(P->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
2983 assert(P->getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
2984 }
2985#endif
2986
2987 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2988 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
2989 void *InsertPos = 0;
2990 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
2991 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2992 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
2993
2994 QualType Canon;
2995 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2996 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
2997 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
2998 ArgPack);
2999 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3000 }
3001
3002 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3003 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3004 ArgPack);
3005 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3006 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3007 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3008}
3009
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003010/// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003011/// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003012/// name.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003013QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003014 bool ParameterPack,
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003015 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003016 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003017 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003018 void *InsertPos = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003019 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003020 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3021
3022 if (TypeParm)
3023 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003024
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003025 if (TTPDecl) {
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003026 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Chandler Carruth08836322011-05-01 00:51:33 +00003027 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003028
3029 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3030 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3031 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3032 (void)TypeCheck;
Anders Carlsson90036dc2009-06-16 00:30:48 +00003033 } else
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003034 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3035 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
Douglas Gregoreff93e02009-02-05 23:33:38 +00003036
3037 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3038 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3039
3040 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3041}
3042
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003043TypeSourceInfo *
3044ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3045 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3046 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003047 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003048 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3049 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003050 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003051
3052 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
David Blaikie6adc78e2013-02-18 22:06:02 +00003053 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3054 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
Abramo Bagnara48c05be2012-02-06 14:41:24 +00003055 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
John McCalle78aac42010-03-10 03:28:59 +00003056 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3057 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3058 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3059 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3060 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3061 return DI;
3062}
3063
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003064QualType
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003065ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003066 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003067 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003068 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3069 "No dependent template names here!");
3070
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003071 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3072
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003073 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003074 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3075 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3076 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3077
John McCall2408e322010-04-27 00:57:59 +00003078 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003079 Underlying);
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003080}
3081
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003082#ifndef NDEBUG
3083static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3084 unsigned NumArgs) {
3085 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3086 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3087 return true;
3088
3089 return true;
3090}
3091#endif
3092
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003093QualType
3094ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00003095 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3096 unsigned NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003097 QualType Underlying) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003098 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3099 "No dependent template names here!");
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003100 // Look through qualified template names.
3101 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3102 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003103
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003104 bool IsTypeAlias =
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003105 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3106 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003107 QualType CanonType;
3108 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3109 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3110 else {
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003111 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3112 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3113 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3114 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3115 IsTypeAlias = false;
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003116 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3117 NumArgs);
3118 }
Douglas Gregord56a91e2009-02-26 22:19:44 +00003119
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003120 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3121 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3122 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003123 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3124 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003125 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003126 TypeAlignment);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003127 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
Douglas Gregor1f79ca82012-02-03 17:16:23 +00003128 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3129 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003130
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003131 Types.push_back(Spec);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003132 return QualType(Spec, 0);
Douglas Gregor8bf42052009-02-09 18:46:07 +00003133}
3134
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003135QualType
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003136ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3137 const TemplateArgument *Args,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003138 unsigned NumArgs) const {
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003139 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3140 "No dependent template names here!");
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003141
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00003142 // Look through qualified template names.
3143 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3144 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
Douglas Gregore16af532011-02-28 18:50:33 +00003145
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003146 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3147 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003148 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003149 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3150 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3151 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3152
3153 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3154 // exists.
3155 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3156 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3157 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3158
3159 void *InsertPos = 0;
3160 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3161 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3162
3163 if (!Spec) {
3164 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3165 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3166 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3167 TypeAlignment);
3168 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3169 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
Richard Smith3f1b5d02011-05-05 21:57:07 +00003170 QualType(), QualType());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis45a83f92010-07-02 11:55:11 +00003171 Types.push_back(Spec);
3172 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3173 }
3174
3175 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3176 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3177 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3178}
3179
3180QualType
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003181ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3182 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003183 QualType NamedType) const {
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003184 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003185 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003186
3187 void *InsertPos = 0;
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003188 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003189 if (T)
3190 return QualType(T, 0);
3191
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003192 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3193 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3194 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003195 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3196 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003197 (void)CheckT;
3198 }
3199
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003200 T = new (*this) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003201 Types.push_back(T);
Abramo Bagnara6150c882010-05-11 21:36:43 +00003202 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor52537682009-03-19 00:18:19 +00003203 return QualType(T, 0);
3204}
3205
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003206QualType
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003207ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
Abramo Bagnara924a8f32010-12-10 16:29:40 +00003208 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3209 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3210
3211 void *InsertPos = 0;
3212 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3213 if (T)
3214 return QualType(T, 0);
3215
3216 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3217 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3218 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3219 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3220 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3221 (void)CheckT;
3222 }
3223
3224 T = new (*this) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3225 Types.push_back(T);
3226 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3227 return QualType(T, 0);
3228}
3229
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003230QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3231 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3232 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003233 QualType Canon) const {
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003234 assert(NNS->isDependent() && "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
3235
3236 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3237 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003238 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3239 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3240 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3241
3242 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3243 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003244 }
3245
3246 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003247 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003248
3249 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003250 DependentNameType *T
3251 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003252 if (T)
3253 return QualType(T, 0);
3254
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003255 T = new (*this) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003256 Types.push_back(T);
Douglas Gregorc1d2d8a2010-03-31 17:34:00 +00003257 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003258 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00003259}
3260
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003261QualType
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003262ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3263 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
Douglas Gregor02085352010-03-31 20:19:30 +00003264 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003265 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003266 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003267 // TODO: avoid this copy
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003268 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003269 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3270 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3271 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3272 ArgCopy.size(),
3273 ArgCopy.data());
3274}
3275
3276QualType
3277ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3278 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3279 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3280 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3281 unsigned NumArgs,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003282 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
Douglas Gregor6e068012011-02-28 00:04:36 +00003283 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3284 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003285
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003286 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003287 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3288 Name, NumArgs, Args);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003289
3290 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003291 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3292 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003293 if (T)
3294 return QualType(T, 0);
3295
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003296 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00003297
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003298 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3299 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3300
3301 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003302 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003303 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3304 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3305 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3306 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003307 }
3308
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003309 QualType Canon;
3310 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3311 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3312 Name, NumArgs,
3313 CanonArgs.data());
3314
3315 // Find the insert position again.
3316 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3317 }
3318
3319 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3320 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3321 TypeAlignment);
John McCall773cc982010-06-11 11:07:21 +00003322 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003323 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003324 Types.push_back(T);
John McCallc392f372010-06-11 00:33:02 +00003325 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003326 return QualType(T, 0);
Douglas Gregordce2b622009-04-01 00:28:59 +00003327}
3328
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003329QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
David Blaikie05785d12013-02-20 22:23:23 +00003330 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003331 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003332 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003333
3334 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3335 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
3336 void *InsertPos = 0;
3337 PackExpansionType *T
3338 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3339 if (T)
3340 return QualType(T, 0);
3341
3342 QualType Canon;
3343 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003344 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3345 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3346 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3347 // parameters.
3348 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3349 Canon = getPackExpansionType(getCanonicalType(Pattern), NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003350
Richard Smith68eea502012-07-16 00:20:35 +00003351 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3352 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3353 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3354 }
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003355 }
3356
Douglas Gregor0dca5fd2011-01-14 17:04:44 +00003357 T = new (*this) PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
Douglas Gregord2fa7662010-12-20 02:24:11 +00003358 Types.push_back(T);
3359 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3360 return QualType(T, 0);
3361}
3362
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003363/// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3364/// alphabetically.
3365static bool CmpProtocolNames(const ObjCProtocolDecl *LHS,
3366 const ObjCProtocolDecl *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor77324f32008-11-17 14:58:09 +00003367 return LHS->getDeclName() < RHS->getDeclName();
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003368}
3369
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003370static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003371 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3372 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3373
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003374 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3375 return false;
3376
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003377 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003378 if (!CmpProtocolNames(Protocols[i-1], Protocols[i]) ||
3379 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003380 return false;
3381 return true;
3382}
3383
3384static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003385 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3386 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003387
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003388 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3389 std::sort(Protocols, Protocols+NumProtocols, CmpProtocolNames);
3390
Douglas Gregorcf9f3ea2012-01-02 02:00:30 +00003391 // Canonicalize.
3392 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3393 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3394
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003395 // Remove duplicates.
3396 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3397 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3398}
3399
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003400QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3401 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003402 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003403 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3404 // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3405 if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3406 return BaseType;
3407
3408 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003409 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003410 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003411 void *InsertPos = 0;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003412 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3413 return QualType(QT, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003414
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003415 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3416 // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003417 QualType Canonical;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003418 bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3419 if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3420 if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00003421 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00003422 Protocols + NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003423 unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3424
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003425 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003426 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3427 &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003428 } else {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003429 Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3430 Protocols, NumProtocols);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003431 }
3432
3433 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003434 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3435 }
3436
3437 unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3438 Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3439 void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3440 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3441 new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3442
3443 Types.push_back(T);
3444 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3445 return QualType(T, 0);
3446}
3447
3448/// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3449/// the given object type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003450QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003451 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3452 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3453
3454 void *InsertPos = 0;
3455 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3456 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3457 return QualType(QT, 0);
3458
3459 // Find the canonical object type.
3460 QualType Canonical;
3461 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3462 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3463
3464 // Regenerate InsertPos.
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003465 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3466 }
3467
Douglas Gregorf85bee62010-02-08 22:59:26 +00003468 // No match.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003469 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3470 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3471 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003472
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003473 Types.push_back(QType);
3474 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003475 return QualType(QType, 0);
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00003476}
Chris Lattnere0ea37a2008-04-07 04:56:42 +00003477
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003478/// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3479/// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003480QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3481 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003482 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3483 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003484
Douglas Gregorab1ec82e2011-12-16 03:12:41 +00003485 if (PrevDecl) {
3486 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3487 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3488 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3489 }
3490
Douglas Gregor7671e532011-12-16 16:34:57 +00003491 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3492 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3493 Decl = Def;
3494
Douglas Gregor1c283312010-08-11 12:19:30 +00003495 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3496 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3497 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3498 Types.push_back(T);
3499 return QualType(T, 0);
Fariborz Jahanian70e8f102007-10-11 00:55:41 +00003500}
3501
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003502/// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3503/// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003504/// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003505/// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003506/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003507QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003508 TypeOfExprType *toe;
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003509 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3510 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3511 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003512
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003513 void *InsertPos = 0;
3514 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3515 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3516 if (Canon) {
3517 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3518 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003519 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003520 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003521 } else {
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003522 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003523 Canon
3524 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
Douglas Gregora5dd9f82009-07-30 23:18:24 +00003525 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3526 toe = Canon;
3527 }
3528 } else {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003529 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003530 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003531 }
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003532 Types.push_back(toe);
3533 return QualType(toe, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003534}
3535
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003536/// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3537/// TypeOfType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3538/// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003539/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003540/// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003541QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00003542 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003543 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
Steve Naroffa773cd52007-08-01 18:02:17 +00003544 Types.push_back(tot);
3545 return QualType(tot, 0);
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00003546}
3547
Anders Carlssonad6bd352009-06-24 21:24:56 +00003548
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003549/// getDecltypeType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3550/// DecltypeType AST's. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3551/// memory savings. Since decltype(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003552/// an issue. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
David Blaikie876657b2011-11-06 22:28:03 +00003553/// on canonical types (which are always unique).
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003554QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003555 DecltypeType *dt;
Douglas Gregor678d76c2011-07-01 01:22:09 +00003556
3557 // C++0x [temp.type]p2:
3558 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
3559 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3560 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
3561 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003562 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3563 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003564
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003565 void *InsertPos = 0;
3566 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3567 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3568 if (Canon) {
3569 // We already have a "canonical" version of an equivalent, dependent
3570 // decltype type. Use that as our canonical type.
Richard Smithef8bf432012-08-13 20:08:14 +00003571 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003572 QualType((DecltypeType*)Canon, 0));
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00003573 } else {
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003574 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
John McCall90d1c2d2009-09-24 23:30:46 +00003575 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
Douglas Gregora21f6c32009-07-30 23:36:40 +00003576 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3577 dt = Canon;
3578 }
3579 } else {
Douglas Gregor81495f32012-02-12 18:42:33 +00003580 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType,
3581 getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Douglas Gregorabd68132009-07-08 00:03:05 +00003582 }
Anders Carlsson81df7b82009-06-24 19:06:50 +00003583 Types.push_back(dt);
3584 return QualType(dt, 0);
3585}
3586
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003587/// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3588/// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3589QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3590 QualType UnderlyingType,
3591 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3592 const {
3593 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
Douglas Gregor6c6e6762011-05-25 17:51:54 +00003594 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3595 Kind,
3596 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
Peter Collingbourne15d48ec2012-03-05 16:02:06 +00003597 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
Alexis Hunte852b102011-05-24 22:41:36 +00003598 Types.push_back(Ty);
3599 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3600}
3601
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003602/// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3603/// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3604/// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3605QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003606 bool IsDependent) const {
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003607 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
3608 return getAutoDeductType();
3609
3610 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003611 void *InsertPos = 0;
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003612 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3613 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
3614 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3615 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003616
Richard Smith74aeef52013-04-26 16:15:35 +00003617 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00003618 IsDecltypeAuto,
3619 IsDependent);
Richard Smithb2bc2e62011-02-21 20:05:19 +00003620 Types.push_back(AT);
3621 if (InsertPos)
3622 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3623 return QualType(AT, 0);
Richard Smith30482bc2011-02-20 03:19:35 +00003624}
3625
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00003626/// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3627/// the given value type.
3628QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3629 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3630 // structure.
3631 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3632 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3633
3634 void *InsertPos = 0;
3635 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3636 return QualType(AT, 0);
3637
3638 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3639 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3640 QualType Canonical;
3641 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3642 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3643
3644 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3645 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3646 assert(NewIP == 0 && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3647 }
3648 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3649 Types.push_back(New);
3650 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3651 return QualType(New, 0);
3652}
3653
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003654/// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3655QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3656 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
Richard Smith2a7d4812013-05-04 07:00:32 +00003657 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3658 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
3659 /*dependent*/false),
3660 0);
Richard Smith02e85f32011-04-14 22:09:26 +00003661 return AutoDeductTy;
3662}
3663
3664/// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3665QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3666 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3667 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3668 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3669 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3670}
3671
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003672/// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3673/// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003674QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
Ted Kremenek2b0ce112007-11-26 21:16:01 +00003675 assert (Decl);
Mike Stumpb93185d2009-08-07 18:05:12 +00003676 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3677 // away const? mutable?
3678 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003679}
3680
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003681/// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3682/// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3683/// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
Anders Carlsson22f443f2009-12-12 00:26:23 +00003684CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003685 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00003686}
Chris Lattnerfb072462007-01-23 05:45:31 +00003687
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003688/// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3689CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3690 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3691}
3692
3693/// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3694CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3695 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3696}
3697
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40e9e482008-08-09 16:51:54 +00003698/// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3699/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3700QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3701 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3702 return WCharTy;
3703}
3704
3705/// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3706/// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3707QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3708 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3709 return UnsignedIntTy;
3710}
3711
Enea Zaffanellaf11ceb62013-01-26 17:08:37 +00003712QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3713 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3714}
3715
3716QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3717 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3718}
3719
Hans Wennborg27541db2011-10-27 08:29:09 +00003720/// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003721/// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3722QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
Douglas Gregore8bbc122011-09-02 00:18:52 +00003723 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
Chris Lattnerd2b88ab2007-07-13 03:05:23 +00003724}
3725
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00003726/// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3727/// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3728QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3729 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3730}
3731
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00003732//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3733// Type Operators
3734//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3735
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003736CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003737 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3738 // qualifiers.
3739 T = getCanonicalType(T);
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003740 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003741 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
John McCallfc93cf92009-10-22 22:37:11 +00003742 QualType Result;
3743 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3744 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3745 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3746 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3747 } else {
3748 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3749 }
3750
3751 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3752}
3753
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003754QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3755 Qualifiers &quals) {
3756 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3757
3758 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3759 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3760 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3761 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3762 const ArrayType *AT =
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003763 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003764
3765 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003766 if (!AT) {
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003767 quals = splitType.Quals;
3768 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003769 }
3770
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003771 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
3772 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
3773 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
3774
3775 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
3776 // can just use the results in splitType.
3777 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
3778 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003779 quals = splitType.Quals;
3780 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003781 }
3782
3783 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
3784 // build the type back up.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00003785 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003786
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003787 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003788 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003789 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
3790 }
3791
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003792 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003793 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003794 }
3795
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003796 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003797 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00003798 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor3b05bdb2010-05-17 18:45:21 +00003799 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
3800 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
3801 VAT->getBracketsRange());
3802 }
3803
3804 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
John McCall6c9dd522011-01-18 07:41:22 +00003805 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00003806 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
3807 SourceRange());
3808}
3809
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003810/// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
3811/// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
3812/// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
3813/// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
3814/// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
3815/// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
3816/// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
3817/// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
3818bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
3819 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
3820 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
3821 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
3822 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
3823 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
3824 return true;
3825 }
3826
3827 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
3828 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3829 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
3830 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
3831 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
3832 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
3833 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
3834 return true;
3835 }
3836
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00003837 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00003838 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
3839 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3840 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
3841 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
3842 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
3843 return true;
3844 }
3845 }
3846
3847 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
3848
3849 return false;
3850}
3851
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003852DeclarationNameInfo
3853ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
3854 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003855 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3856 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
3857 case TemplateName::Template:
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003858 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003859 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
3860 NameLoc);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003861
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003862 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
3863 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
3864 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
3865 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
3866 }
3867
3868 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
3869 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003870 DeclarationName DName;
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003871 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003872 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
3873 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003874 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003875 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
3876 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
3877 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
3878 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
3879 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
3880 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003881 }
3882 }
3883
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003884 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
3885 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
3886 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
3887 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
3888 NameLoc);
3889 }
3890
3891 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
3892 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
3893 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
3894 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
3895 NameLoc);
3896 }
3897 }
3898
3899 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
John McCall847e2a12009-11-24 18:42:40 +00003900}
3901
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003902TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003903 switch (Name.getKind()) {
3904 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
3905 case TemplateName::Template: {
3906 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00003907 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003908 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00003909 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
3910
3911 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6b7e3762009-07-18 00:34:25 +00003912 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
Douglas Gregor7dbfb462010-06-16 21:09:37 +00003913 }
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00003914
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003915 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
3916 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003917
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00003918 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
3919 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
3920 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
3921 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
3922 }
3923
3924 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
3925 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
3926 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
3927 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
3928 }
3929
3930 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
3931 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
3932 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
3933 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
3934 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
3935 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
3936 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
3937 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
3938 }
3939 }
3940
3941 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
Douglas Gregor6bc50582009-05-07 06:41:52 +00003942}
3943
Douglas Gregoradee3e32009-11-11 23:06:43 +00003944bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
3945 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
3946 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
3947 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
3948}
3949
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003950TemplateArgument
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00003951ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003952 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
3953 case TemplateArgument::Null:
3954 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003955
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003956 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003957 return Arg;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003958
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00003959 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00003960 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
3961 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.isDeclForReferenceParam());
Douglas Gregor31f55dc2012-04-06 22:40:38 +00003962 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003963
Eli Friedmanb826a002012-09-26 02:36:12 +00003964 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
3965 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
3966 /*isNullPtr*/true);
3967
Douglas Gregor9167f8b2009-11-11 01:00:40 +00003968 case TemplateArgument::Template:
3969 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00003970
3971 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
3972 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
3973 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
Douglas Gregore1d60df2011-01-14 23:41:42 +00003974 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
Douglas Gregore4ff4b52011-01-05 18:58:31 +00003975
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003976 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
Benjamin Kramer6003ad52012-06-07 15:09:51 +00003977 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003978
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003979 case TemplateArgument::Type:
John McCall0ad16662009-10-29 08:12:44 +00003980 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003981
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003982 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
Douglas Gregor0192c232010-12-20 16:52:59 +00003983 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
3984 return Arg;
3985
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00003986 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
3987 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003988 unsigned Idx = 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003989 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003990 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
3991 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
3992 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003993
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00003994 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00003995 }
3996 }
3997
3998 // Silence GCC warning
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00003999 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
Douglas Gregora8e02e72009-07-28 23:00:59 +00004000}
4001
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004002NestedNameSpecifier *
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004003ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004004 if (!NNS)
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004005 return 0;
4006
4007 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4008 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4009 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004010 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004011 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4012 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4013
4014 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4015 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4016 // this namespace and no prefix.
Douglas Gregor7b26ff92011-02-24 02:36:08 +00004017 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4018 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4019
4020 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4021 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4022 // this namespace and no prefix.
4023 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0,
4024 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4025 ->getOriginalNamespace());
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004026
4027 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4028 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4029 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004030
4031 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4032 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4033 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4034 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4035 // types, e.g.,
4036 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4037 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004038 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4039 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004040 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor3ade5702010-11-04 00:09:33 +00004041
Eli Friedman5358a0a2012-03-03 04:09:56 +00004042 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4043 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4044 // first place?
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004045 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, 0, false,
4046 const_cast<Type*>(T.getTypePtr()));
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004047 }
4048
4049 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4050 // The global specifier is canonical and unique.
4051 return NNS;
4052 }
4053
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00004054 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
Douglas Gregor333489b2009-03-27 23:10:48 +00004055}
4056
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004057
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004058const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004059 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004060 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004061 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4062 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4063 return AT;
4064 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004065
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004066 // Handle the common negative case fast.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004067 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004068 return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004069
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004070 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004071 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4072 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004073
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004074 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4075 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
Douglas Gregor2211d342009-08-05 05:36:45 +00004076 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004077
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004078 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004079 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004080
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004081 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004082 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004083 if (ATy == 0 || qs.empty())
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004084 return ATy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004085
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004086 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4087 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004088 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004089
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004090 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4091 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4092 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004093 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004094 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4095 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4096 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004097 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004098
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004099 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004100 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4101 return cast<ArrayType>(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004102 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004103 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004104 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004105 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004106 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004107
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004108 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004109 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00004110 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004111 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004112 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00004113 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
Chris Lattnered0d0792008-04-06 22:41:35 +00004114}
4115
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004116QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004117 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
4118 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
4119 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
4120 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
4121 // the array type derivation.
4122 if (T->isArrayType())
4123 return getArrayDecayedType(T);
4124
4125 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
4126 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
4127 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
4128 // in 6.3.2.1.
4129 if (T->isFunctionType())
4130 return getPointerType(T);
4131
4132 return T;
4133}
4134
Abramo Bagnarae1decdf2012-05-17 12:44:05 +00004135QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor84280642011-07-12 04:42:08 +00004136 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4137 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4138 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4139}
4140
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004141/// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4142/// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4143/// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4144/// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4145///
4146/// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004147QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004148 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4149 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4150 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4151 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4152 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4153 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004154
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004155 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004156
4157 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004158 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
Chris Lattnera21ad802008-04-02 05:18:44 +00004159}
4160
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004161QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4162 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor79f83ed2009-07-23 23:49:00 +00004163}
4164
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004165QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4166 Qualifiers qs;
4167 while (true) {
4168 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004169 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004170 if (!array) break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004171
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004172 type = array->getElementType();
John McCall18ce25e2012-02-08 00:46:36 +00004173 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004174 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004175
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004176 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
Anders Carlssone0808df2008-12-21 03:44:36 +00004177}
4178
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004179/// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004180uint64_t
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004181ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4182 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4183 do {
4184 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
Richard Smith7808c6a2012-12-06 03:04:50 +00004185 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4186 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
Fariborz Jahanian6c9e5a22009-08-21 16:31:06 +00004187 } while (CA);
4188 return ElementCount;
4189}
4190
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004191/// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4192/// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004193static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004194 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004195 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004196
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004197 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4198 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004199 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
Anton Korobeynikovf0c267e2011-10-14 23:23:15 +00004200 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
Chris Lattnerc6395932007-06-22 20:56:16 +00004201 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4202 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4203 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004204 }
4205}
4206
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004207/// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4208/// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
Steve Narofffc6ffa22007-08-27 01:41:48 +00004209/// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4210/// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004211QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4212 QualType Domain) const {
4213 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4214 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4215 switch (EltRank) {
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004216 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004217 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4218 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4219 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4220 }
Steve Naroff0af91202007-04-27 21:51:21 +00004221 }
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004222
4223 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4224 switch (EltRank) {
Joey Goulydd7f4562013-01-23 11:56:20 +00004225 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
Chris Lattnerb9dfb032008-04-06 23:58:54 +00004226 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4227 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4228 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
Steve Naroff9091ef72007-08-27 01:27:54 +00004229 }
David Blaikief47fa302012-01-17 02:30:50 +00004230 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004231}
4232
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004233/// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4234/// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4235/// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004236/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004237int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004238 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4239 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004240
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004241 if (LHSR == RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004242 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb90739d2008-04-06 23:38:49 +00004243 if (LHSR > RHSR)
Steve Naroff7af82d42007-08-27 15:30:22 +00004244 return 1;
4245 return -1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004246}
4247
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004248/// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4249/// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4250/// or if it is not canonicalized.
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004251unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00004252 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
Alisdair Mereditha9ad47d2009-07-14 06:30:34 +00004253
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004254 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00004255 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004256 case BuiltinType::Bool:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004257 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004258 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4259 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4260 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4261 case BuiltinType::UChar:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004262 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004263 case BuiltinType::Short:
4264 case BuiltinType::UShort:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004265 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004266 case BuiltinType::Int:
4267 case BuiltinType::UInt:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004268 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004269 case BuiltinType::Long:
4270 case BuiltinType::ULong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004271 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004272 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4273 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00004274 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00004275 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4276 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4277 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004278 }
4279}
4280
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004281/// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4282/// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4283///
4284/// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4285/// promotion occurs.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004286QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
Douglas Gregore05d3cb2010-05-24 20:13:53 +00004287 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4288 return QualType();
4289
John McCalld25db7e2013-05-06 21:39:12 +00004290 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004291 if (!Field)
4292 return QualType();
4293
4294 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4295
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00004296 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00004297 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4298 // GCC extension compatibility: if the bit-field size is less than or equal
4299 // to the size of int, it gets promoted no matter what its type is.
4300 // For instance, unsigned long bf : 4 gets promoted to signed int.
4301 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4302 return IntTy;
4303
4304 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4305 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4306
4307 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4308 // like the base type.
4309 // FIXME: This doesn't quite match what gcc does, but what gcc does here
4310 // is ridiculous.
4311 return QualType();
4312}
4313
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004314/// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4315/// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4316/// integer type.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004317QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004318 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4319 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00004320 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4321 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
Eli Friedman3f37c1c2011-10-26 07:22:48 +00004322
4323 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4324 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4325 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4326 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4327 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4328 // unsigned long long int [...]
4329 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4330 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4331 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4332 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4333 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4334 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4335 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4336 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4337 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4338 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4339 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4340 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4341 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4342 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4343 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4344 }
4345 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4346 }
4347 }
4348
4349 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004350 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4351 return IntTy;
Eli Friedman6745c3b2012-11-15 01:21:59 +00004352 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4353 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00004354 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4355 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4356}
4357
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004358/// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4359/// type and returns its ownership.
4360Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4361 while (!T.isNull()) {
4362 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4363 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4364 if (T->isArrayType())
4365 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4366 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4367 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4368 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Argyrios Kyrtzidis8e252532011-07-01 23:01:46 +00004369 T = RT->getPointeeType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis7451d1c2011-07-01 22:22:50 +00004370 else
4371 break;
4372 }
4373
4374 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4375}
4376
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004377/// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004378/// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004379/// LHS < RHS, return -1.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004380int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00004381 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4382 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004383 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004384
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004385 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4386 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004387
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004388 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4389 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004390
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004391 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4392 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4393 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4394 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004395
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004396 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4397 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4398 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4399 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4400 return 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004401
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004402 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4403 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004404 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004405 return -1;
4406 }
Chris Lattner76a00cf2008-04-06 22:59:24 +00004407
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004408 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4409 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4410 return -1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004411
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004412 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4413 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004414 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
Chris Lattnerd4bacd62008-04-06 23:55:33 +00004415 return 1;
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00004416}
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004417
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004418static RecordDecl *
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004419CreateRecordDecl(const ASTContext &Ctx, RecordDecl::TagKind TK,
4420 DeclContext *DC, IdentifierInfo *Id) {
4421 SourceLocation Loc;
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00004422 if (Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004423 return CXXRecordDecl::Create(Ctx, TK, DC, Loc, Loc, Id);
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004424 else
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004425 return RecordDecl::Create(Ctx, TK, DC, Loc, Loc, Id);
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004426}
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004427
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004428// getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004429QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004430 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004431 CFConstantStringTypeDecl =
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004432 CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004433 &Idents.get("NSConstantString"));
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004434 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004435
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004436 QualType FieldTypes[4];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004437
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004438 // const int *isa;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004439 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson9c1011c2007-11-19 00:25:30 +00004440 // int flags;
4441 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004442 // const char *str;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004443 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004444 // long length;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004445 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4446
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004447 // Create fields
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004448 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004449 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004450 SourceLocation(),
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004451 SourceLocation(), 0,
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004452 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004453 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004454 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004455 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004456 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004457 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00004458 }
4459
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004460 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004461 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004462
Anders Carlsson98f07902007-08-17 05:31:46 +00004463 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
Gabor Greif412af032007-09-11 15:32:40 +00004464}
Anders Carlsson87c149b2007-10-11 01:00:40 +00004465
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00004466QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4467 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
4468 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl =
4469 CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl, &Idents.get("objc_super"));
4470 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4471 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4472 }
4473 return ObjCSuperType;
4474}
4475
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004476void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004477 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregor512b0772009-04-23 22:29:11 +00004478 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4479 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4480}
4481
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004482QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004483 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4484 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4485
4486 RecordDecl *T;
4487 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004488 T = CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004489 &Idents.get("__block_descriptor"));
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004490 T->startDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004491
4492 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4493 UnsignedLongTy,
4494 UnsignedLongTy,
4495 };
4496
4497 const char *FieldNames[] = {
4498 "reserved",
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004499 "Size"
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004500 };
4501
4502 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004503 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, T, SourceLocation(),
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004504 SourceLocation(),
4505 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004506 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004507 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004508 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004509 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004510 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004511 T->addDecl(Field);
4512 }
4513
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004514 T->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpd0153282009-10-20 02:12:22 +00004515
4516 BlockDescriptorType = T;
4517
4518 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4519}
4520
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004521QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004522 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4523 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4524
4525 RecordDecl *T;
4526 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
Abramo Bagnara29c2d462011-03-09 14:09:51 +00004527 T = CreateRecordDecl(*this, TTK_Struct, TUDecl,
Anders Carlsson6d417272009-11-14 21:45:58 +00004528 &Idents.get("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose"));
John McCallae580fe2010-02-05 01:33:36 +00004529 T->startDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004530
4531 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4532 UnsignedLongTy,
4533 UnsignedLongTy,
4534 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4535 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4536 };
4537
4538 const char *FieldNames[] = {
4539 "reserved",
4540 "Size",
4541 "CopyFuncPtr",
4542 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4543 };
4544
4545 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
Abramo Bagnaradff19302011-03-08 08:55:46 +00004546 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, T, SourceLocation(),
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004547 SourceLocation(),
4548 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00004549 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004550 /*BitWidth=*/0,
Richard Smith938f40b2011-06-11 17:19:42 +00004551 /*Mutable=*/false,
Richard Smith2b013182012-06-10 03:12:00 +00004552 ICIS_NoInit);
John McCall4d4dcc82010-04-30 21:35:41 +00004553 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004554 T->addDecl(Field);
4555 }
4556
Douglas Gregord5058122010-02-11 01:19:42 +00004557 T->completeDefinition();
Mike Stumpe1b19ba2009-10-22 00:49:09 +00004558
4559 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = T;
4560
4561 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4562}
4563
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004564/// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4565/// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4566/// in buildByrefHelpers.
4567bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4568 const VarDecl *D) {
4569 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4570 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4571 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4572
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004573 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniana00076c2010-11-17 00:21:28 +00004574 }
Fariborz Jahanian998f0a32012-11-28 23:12:17 +00004575
4576 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4577
4578 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4579
4580 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4581 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4582 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4583
4584 switch (lifetime) {
4585 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4586
4587 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4588 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4589 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4590 return false;
4591
4592 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4593 // byref routines.
4594 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4595 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4596 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4597 return true;
4598 }
4599 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4600 }
4601 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4602 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
Mike Stump94967902009-10-21 18:16:27 +00004603}
4604
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004605bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4606 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4607 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4608
4609 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4610 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4611 return false;
4612
4613 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
Fariborz Jahanianf762b722012-12-11 19:58:01 +00004614 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniana9d44642012-11-14 17:15:51 +00004615 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4616 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4617 }
4618 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4619 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4620 // MRR.
4621 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4622 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4623 else
4624 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4625 return true;
4626}
4627
Douglas Gregorbab8a962011-09-08 01:46:34 +00004628TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4629 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
4630 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(*this,
4631 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
4632 SourceLocation(),
4633 SourceLocation(),
4634 &Idents.get("instancetype"),
4635 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(getObjCIdType()));
4636 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4637}
4638
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004639// This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4640// typedef <type> BOOL;
Chris Lattnere0218992007-10-30 20:27:44 +00004641static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00004642 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
Chris Lattner9b1f2792008-11-24 03:52:59 +00004643 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4644 return II->isStr("BOOL");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004645
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00004646 return false;
4647}
4648
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004649/// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004650/// purpose.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004651CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004652 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4653 return CharUnits::Zero();
4654
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004655 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004656
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004657 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004658 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004659 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004660 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4661 else if (type->isArrayType())
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004662 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004663 return sz;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004664}
4665
4666static inline
4667std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4668 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004669}
4670
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004671/// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004672/// declaration.
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004673std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4674 std::string S;
4675
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004676 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4677 QualType BlockTy =
4678 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4679 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004680 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004681 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None,
4682 BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType(),
4683 S, true /*Extended*/);
4684 else
4685 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getResultType(),
4686 S);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004687 // Compute size of all parameters.
4688 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4689 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4690 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004691 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4692 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
Fariborz Jahanian590c3522010-04-08 18:06:22 +00004693 for (BlockDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004694 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4695 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004696 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahaniand4879412012-06-30 00:48:59 +00004697 if (sz.isZero())
4698 continue;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004699 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004700 ParmOffset += sz;
4701 }
4702 // Size of the argument frame
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004703 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004704 // Block pointer and offset.
4705 S += "@?0";
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004706
4707 // Argument types.
4708 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
4709 for (BlockDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(), E =
4710 Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4711 ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
4712 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4713 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4714 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4715 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4716 // elements.
4717 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4718 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4719 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4720 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian0e3043b2012-11-15 19:02:45 +00004721 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
Fariborz Jahanian64223e62012-11-14 23:11:38 +00004722 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4723 S, true /*Extended*/);
4724 else
4725 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004726 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004727 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004728 }
John McCall351762c2011-02-07 10:33:21 +00004729
4730 return S;
David Chisnall950a9512009-11-17 19:33:30 +00004731}
4732
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004733bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004734 std::string& S) {
4735 // Encode result type.
4736 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getResultType(), S);
4737 CharUnits ParmOffset;
4738 // Compute size of all parameters.
4739 for (FunctionDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
4740 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4741 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
4742 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004743 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004744 continue;
4745
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004746 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004747 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004748 ParmOffset += sz;
4749 }
4750 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4751 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4752
4753 // Argument types.
4754 for (FunctionDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
4755 E = Decl->param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
4756 ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
4757 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4758 if (const ArrayType *AT =
4759 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4760 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4761 // elements.
4762 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4763 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4764 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4765 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4766 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4767 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4768 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4769 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004770
4771 return false;
David Chisnall50e4eba2010-12-30 14:05:53 +00004772}
4773
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004774/// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
4775/// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
4776/// block object types.
4777void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
4778 QualType T, std::string& S,
4779 bool Extended) const {
4780 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
4781 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
4782 // Encode parameter type.
4783 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, 0,
4784 true /*OutermostType*/,
4785 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
4786 false /*StructField*/,
4787 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
4788 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
4789}
4790
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00004791/// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004792/// declaration.
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004793bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004794 std::string& S,
4795 bool Extended) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004796 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004797 // Encode return type.
4798 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4799 Decl->getResultType(), S, Extended);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004800 // Compute size of all parameters.
4801 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4802 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4803 SourceLocation Loc;
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004804 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004805 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
4806 // their size.
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004807 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004808 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004809 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Chris Lattnera4997152009-02-20 18:43:26 +00004810 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004811 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004812 if (sz.isZero())
Fariborz Jahanian271b8d42012-06-29 22:54:56 +00004813 continue;
4814
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004815 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4816 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004817 ParmOffset += sz;
4818 }
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004819 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004820 S += "@0:";
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004821 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004822
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004823 // Argument types.
4824 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004825 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand9235db2010-04-08 21:29:11 +00004826 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb8c3aaf2011-10-03 06:37:04 +00004827 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004828 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
Fariborz Jahaniana0befc02008-12-20 23:29:59 +00004829 if (const ArrayType *AT =
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004830 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4831 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4832 // elements.
Steve Naroff323827e2009-04-14 00:40:09 +00004833 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
Steve Naroffe4e55d22009-04-14 00:03:58 +00004834 PType = PVDecl->getType();
4835 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4836 PType = PVDecl->getType();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00004837 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
4838 PType, S, Extended);
Ken Dyck40775002010-01-11 17:06:35 +00004839 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
Ken Dyckde37a672010-01-11 19:19:56 +00004840 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004841 }
Douglas Gregora9d84932011-05-27 01:19:52 +00004842
4843 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian797f24c2007-10-29 22:57:28 +00004844}
4845
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004846/// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004847/// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004848/// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
4849/// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004850/// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
4851/// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
4852/// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
4853/// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
4854/// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004855/// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
4856/// @code
4857/// enum PropertyAttributes {
4858/// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
4859/// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
4860/// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
4861/// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
4862/// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
4863/// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
4864/// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
Bob Wilson8cf61852012-03-22 17:48:02 +00004865/// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
Fariborz Jahanian2f85a642009-01-20 20:04:12 +00004866/// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
4867/// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
4868/// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
4869/// };
4870/// @endcode
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004871void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004872 const Decl *Container,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004873 std::string& S) const {
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004874 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
4875 bool Dynamic = false;
4876 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = 0;
4877
4878 // FIXME: Duplicated code due to poor abstraction.
4879 if (Container) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004880 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004881 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
4882 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004883 i = CID->propimpl_begin(), e = CID->propimpl_end();
Douglas Gregor29bd76f2009-04-23 01:02:12 +00004884 i != e; ++i) {
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00004885 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004886 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) {
4887 if (PID->getPropertyImplementation()==ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) {
4888 Dynamic = true;
4889 } else {
4890 SynthesizePID = PID;
4891 }
4892 }
4893 }
4894 } else {
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00004895 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004896 for (ObjCCategoryImplDecl::propimpl_iterator
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004897 i = OID->propimpl_begin(), e = OID->propimpl_end();
Douglas Gregor29bd76f2009-04-23 01:02:12 +00004898 i != e; ++i) {
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00004899 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PID = *i;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004900 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD) {
4901 if (PID->getPropertyImplementation()==ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic) {
4902 Dynamic = true;
4903 } else {
4904 SynthesizePID = PID;
4905 }
4906 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004907 }
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004908 }
4909 }
4910
4911 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
4912 S = "T";
4913
4914 // Encode result type.
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00004915 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
4916 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004917 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PD->getType(), S, true, true, 0,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00004918 true /* outermost type */,
4919 true /* encoding for property */);
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004920
4921 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
4922 S += ",R";
Nico Weber4e8626f2013-05-08 23:47:40 +00004923 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
4924 S += ",C";
4925 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
4926 S += ",&";
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004927 } else {
4928 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
4929 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
4930 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004931 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
Fariborz Jahanian70a315c2011-08-12 20:47:08 +00004932 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004933 }
4934 }
4935
4936 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
4937 // are "dynamic by default".
4938 if (Dynamic)
4939 S += ",D";
4940
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00004941 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
4942 S += ",N";
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004943
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004944 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
4945 S += ",G";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00004946 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004947 }
4948
4949 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
4950 S += ",S";
Chris Lattnere4b95692008-11-24 03:33:13 +00004951 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004952 }
4953
4954 if (SynthesizePID) {
4955 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
4956 S += ",V";
Chris Lattner1cbaacc2008-11-24 04:00:27 +00004957 S += OID->getNameAsString();
Daniel Dunbar4932b362008-08-28 04:38:10 +00004958 }
4959
4960 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
4961}
4962
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00004963/// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004964/// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
4965/// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00004966/// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
4967///
4968void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00004969 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004970 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004971 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00004972 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004973 else
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004974 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00004975 PointeeTy = IntTy;
4976 }
4977 }
4978}
4979
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00004980void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00004981 const FieldDecl *Field) const {
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00004982 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
4983 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
4984 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
4985 // same type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004986 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
Fariborz Jahaniandaef00b2008-12-22 23:22:27 +00004987 true /* outermost type */);
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00004988}
4989
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00004990static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
4991 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
4992 switch (kind) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00004993 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
4994 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
4995 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4996 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00004997 case BuiltinType::Char16:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00004998 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00004999 case BuiltinType::Char32:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005000 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5001 case BuiltinType::ULong:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005002 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005003 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5004 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5005 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5006 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5007 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
Chris Lattnerad3467e2010-12-25 23:25:43 +00005008 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5009 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005010 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5011 case BuiltinType::Long:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005012 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005013 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5014 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5015 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5016 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
Daniel Dunbar7cba5a72010-10-11 21:13:48 +00005017 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005018 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5019
5020 case BuiltinType::Half:
5021 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5022 return ' ';
5023
5024 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5025 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5026 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5027 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5028
5029 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5030 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5031 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5032 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5033 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5034 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5035 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
Guy Benyei1b4fb3e2013-01-20 12:31:11 +00005036 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
Guy Benyei61054192013-02-07 10:55:47 +00005037 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005038 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5039#define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5040#define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5041 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5042#include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5043 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005044 }
David Blaikie5a6a0202013-01-09 17:48:41 +00005045 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005046}
5047
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005048static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5049 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5050
5051 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5052 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5053 return 'i';
5054
5055 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005056 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5057 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005058}
5059
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00005060static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005061 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005062 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005063 S += 'b';
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005064 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5065 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5066 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5067 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5068 //
5069 // struct
5070 // {
5071 // int integer;
5072 // int flags:2;
5073 // };
5074 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5075 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5076 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5077 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5078 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
John McCall5fb5df92012-06-20 06:18:46 +00005079 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005080 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5081 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
Eli Friedmana3c122d2011-07-07 01:54:01 +00005082 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
Douglas Gregor8b7d4032011-09-08 17:18:35 +00005083 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5084 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005085 else {
5086 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5087 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5088 }
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005089 }
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005090 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
Fariborz Jahanian5c767722009-01-13 01:18:13 +00005091}
5092
Daniel Dunbar07d07852009-10-18 21:17:35 +00005093// FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
Daniel Dunbar3cd9a292008-10-17 07:30:50 +00005094void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5095 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5096 bool ExpandStructures,
Daniel Dunbarc040ce42009-04-20 06:37:24 +00005097 const FieldDecl *FD,
Fariborz Jahanian218c6302009-01-20 19:14:18 +00005098 bool OutermostType,
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005099 bool EncodingProperty,
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005100 bool StructField,
5101 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005102 bool EncodeClassNames,
5103 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) const {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005104 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5105 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5106 case Type::Builtin:
5107 case Type::Enum:
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005108 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
David Chisnallb190a2c2010-06-04 01:10:52 +00005109 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005110 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5111 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5112 else
5113 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005114 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005115
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005116 case Type::Complex: {
5117 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005118 S += 'j';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005119 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, 0, false,
Anders Carlsson39b2e132009-04-09 21:55:45 +00005120 false);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005121 return;
5122 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005123
5124 case Type::Atomic: {
5125 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5126 S += 'A';
5127 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, 0,
5128 false, false);
5129 return;
Fariborz Jahanian9ffd7062010-04-13 23:45:47 +00005130 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005131
5132 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5133 case Type::Pointer:
5134 case Type::LValueReference:
5135 case Type::RValueReference: {
5136 QualType PointeeTy;
5137 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5138 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5139 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5140 S += ':';
5141 return;
5142 }
5143 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5144 } else {
5145 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5146 }
5147
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005148 bool isReadOnly = false;
5149 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5150 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5151 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005152 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00005153 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005154 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5155 isReadOnly = true;
5156 S += 'r';
5157 }
Mike Stumpe9c6ffc2009-07-31 02:02:20 +00005158 } else if (OutermostType) {
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005159 QualType P = PointeeTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005160 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5161 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005162 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5163 isReadOnly = true;
5164 S += 'r';
5165 }
5166 }
5167 if (isReadOnly) {
5168 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5169 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5170 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00005171 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
Benjamin Kramer2e3197e2010-04-27 17:12:11 +00005172 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005173 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005174
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005175 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5176 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5177 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
Anders Carlsson18acd442007-10-29 06:33:42 +00005178 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005179 S += '*';
5180 return;
5181 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005182 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Steve Naroff3de6b702009-07-22 17:14:51 +00005183 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5184 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5185 S += '#';
5186 return;
5187 }
5188 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5189 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5190 S += '@';
5191 return;
5192 }
5193 // fall through...
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005194 }
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005195 S += '^';
Fariborz Jahanian0f66a6c2008-12-23 19:56:47 +00005196 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5197
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005198 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005199 NULL);
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005200 return;
5201 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005202
5203 case Type::ConstantArray:
5204 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5205 case Type::VariableArray: {
5206 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5207
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005208 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005209 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5210 S += '^';
5211
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005212 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005213 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5214 } else {
5215 S += '[';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005216
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005217 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
5218 if (getTypeSize(CAT->getElementType()) == 0)
5219 S += '0';
5220 else
5221 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5222 } else {
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005223 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005224 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5225 "Unknown array type!");
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005226 S += '0';
5227 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005228
5229 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
Anders Carlssond05f44b2009-02-22 01:38:57 +00005230 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5231 S += ']';
5232 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005233 return;
5234 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005235
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005236 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5237 case Type::FunctionProto:
Anders Carlssondf4cc612007-10-30 00:06:20 +00005238 S += '?';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005239 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005240
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005241 case Type::Record: {
5242 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005243 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005244 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5245 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5246 S += II->getName();
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005247 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5248 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5249 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Benjamin Kramer9170e912013-02-22 15:46:01 +00005250 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5251 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
Douglas Gregor1ccc8412010-11-07 23:05:16 +00005252 TemplateArgs.data(),
5253 TemplateArgs.size(),
Douglas Gregorc0b07282011-09-27 22:38:19 +00005254 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
Fariborz Jahanianc5158202010-05-07 00:28:49 +00005255 }
Daniel Dunbar40cac772008-10-17 06:22:57 +00005256 } else {
5257 S += '?';
5258 }
Daniel Dunbarfc1066d2008-10-17 20:21:44 +00005259 if (ExpandStructures) {
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005260 S += '=';
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005261 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5262 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD);
5263 } else {
5264 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5265 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5266 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
5267 if (FD) {
5268 S += '"';
5269 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5270 S += '"';
5271 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005272
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005273 // Special case bit-fields.
5274 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5275 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005276 *Field);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005277 } else {
5278 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5279 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5280 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5281 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5282 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5283 /*StructField*/true);
5284 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005285 }
Fariborz Jahanian0a71ad22008-01-22 22:44:46 +00005286 }
Fariborz Jahanianbc92fd72007-11-13 23:21:38 +00005287 }
Daniel Dunbarff3c6742008-10-17 16:17:37 +00005288 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005289 return;
5290 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005291
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005292 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5293 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
Steve Naroff49140cb2009-02-02 18:24:29 +00005294 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005295 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005296 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005297
5298 S += '<';
5299 // Block return type
5300 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(FT->getResultType(), S,
5301 ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5302 FD,
5303 false /* OutermostType */,
5304 EncodingProperty,
5305 false /* StructField */,
5306 EncodeBlockParameters,
5307 EncodeClassNames);
5308 // Block self
5309 S += "@?";
5310 // Block parameters
5311 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
5312 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator I = FPT->arg_type_begin(),
5313 E = FPT->arg_type_end(); I && (I != E); ++I) {
5314 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(*I, S,
5315 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5316 ExpandStructures,
5317 FD,
5318 false /* OutermostType */,
5319 EncodingProperty,
5320 false /* StructField */,
5321 EncodeBlockParameters,
5322 EncodeClassNames);
5323 }
5324 }
5325 S += '>';
5326 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005327 return;
5328 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005329
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005330 case Type::ObjCObject:
5331 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5332 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5333 T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005334
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005335 // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5336 // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5337 const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005338 // @encode(class_name)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00005339 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005340 S += '{';
5341 const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5342 S += II->getName();
5343 S += '=';
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005344 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005345 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5346 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Jordy Rosea91768e2011-07-22 02:08:32 +00005347 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
Fariborz Jahaniana50b3a22010-08-20 21:21:08 +00005348 if (Field->isBitField())
5349 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005350 else
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005351 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5352 false, false, false, false, false,
5353 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef);
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005354 }
5355 S += '}';
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005356 return;
Fariborz Jahanian1d35f122008-12-19 23:34:38 +00005357 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005358
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005359 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5360 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005361 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5362 S += '@';
5363 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005364 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005365
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005366 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5367 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5368 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5369 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005370 S += '#';
5371 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005372 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005373
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005374 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005375 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005376 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5377 ExpandStructures, FD);
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005378 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005379 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5380 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005381 S += '"';
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005382 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5383 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005384 S += '<';
5385 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5386 S += '>';
5387 }
5388 S += '"';
5389 }
5390 return;
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005391 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005392
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005393 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5394 if (!EncodingProperty &&
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005395 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5396 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005397 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005398 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005399 // {...};
5400 S += '^';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005401 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5402 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
Fariborz Jahaniand4c1a202013-02-15 21:14:50 +00005403 NULL,
5404 false, false, false, false, false,
5405 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005406 return;
5407 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005408
5409 S += '@';
Bob Wilson5f4e3a72011-11-30 01:57:58 +00005410 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5411 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005412 S += '"';
Steve Narofff0c86112009-10-28 22:03:49 +00005413 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005414 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = OPT->qual_begin(),
5415 E = OPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005416 S += '<';
5417 S += (*I)->getNameAsString();
5418 S += '>';
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005419 }
Chris Lattnere7cabb92009-07-13 00:10:46 +00005420 S += '"';
5421 }
5422 return;
5423 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005424
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005425 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005426 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5427 case Type::MemberPointer:
John McCalla9e6e8d2010-05-17 23:56:34 +00005428 return;
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005429
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005430 case Type::Vector:
5431 case Type::ExtVector:
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005432 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is
5433 // insufficient.
5434 // FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5435 return;
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005436
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00005437 case Type::Auto:
5438 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5439 // Just ignore it.
5440 return;
5441
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005442#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5443#define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5444#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5445 case Type::KIND:
5446#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5447 case Type::KIND:
5448#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5449 case Type::KIND:
5450#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5451 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
Fariborz Jahaniane0587be2010-10-07 21:25:25 +00005452 }
John McCall393a78d2012-12-20 02:45:14 +00005453 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
Anders Carlssond8499822007-10-29 05:01:08 +00005454}
5455
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005456void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5457 std::string &S,
5458 const FieldDecl *FD,
5459 bool includeVBases) const {
5460 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5461 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5462 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5463 return;
5464
5465 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5466 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5467 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5468
5469 if (CXXRec) {
5470 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator
5471 BI = CXXRec->bases_begin(),
5472 BE = CXXRec->bases_end(); BI != BE; ++BI) {
5473 if (!BI->isVirtual()) {
5474 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005475 if (base->isEmpty())
5476 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005477 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005478 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5479 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5480 }
5481 }
5482 }
5483
5484 unsigned i = 0;
5485 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator Field = RDecl->field_begin(),
5486 FieldEnd = RDecl->field_end();
5487 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field, ++i) {
5488 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5489 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
David Blaikie40ed2972012-06-06 20:45:41 +00005490 std::make_pair(offs, *Field));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005491 }
5492
5493 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
5494 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator
5495 BI = CXXRec->vbases_begin(),
5496 BE = CXXRec->vbases_end(); BI != BE; ++BI) {
5497 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005498 if (base->isEmpty())
5499 continue;
Benjamin Kramer2ef30312012-07-04 18:45:14 +00005500 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis81c0b5c2011-09-26 18:14:24 +00005501 if (FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
5502 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5503 std::make_pair(offs, base));
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005504 }
5505 }
5506
5507 CharUnits size;
5508 if (CXXRec) {
5509 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5510 } else {
5511 size = layout.getSize();
5512 }
5513
5514 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
5515 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5516 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5517
Douglas Gregorf5d6c742012-04-27 22:30:01 +00005518 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5519 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005520 if (FD) {
5521 S += "\"_vptr$";
5522 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5523 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5524 S += recname;
5525 S += '"';
5526 }
5527 S += "^^?";
5528 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
5529 }
5530
5531 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5532 // Mark the end of the structure.
5533 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5534 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5535 std::make_pair(offs, (NamedDecl*)0));
5536 }
5537
5538 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
5539 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
5540
5541 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5542 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5543 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5544 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5545 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5546 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5547 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5548 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5549 // longer then though.
5550 CurOffs += padding;
5551 }
5552
5553 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
5554 if (dcl == 0)
5555 break; // reached end of structure.
5556
5557 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5558 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5559 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5560 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5561 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5562 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis95a76f32011-06-17 23:19:38 +00005563 assert(!base->isEmpty());
5564 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005565 } else {
5566 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5567 if (FD) {
5568 S += '"';
5569 S += field->getNameAsString();
5570 S += '"';
5571 }
5572
5573 if (field->isBitField()) {
5574 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
Richard Smithcaf33902011-10-10 18:28:20 +00005575 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis49b35de2011-05-17 00:46:38 +00005576 } else {
5577 QualType qt = field->getType();
5578 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5579 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5580 /*OutermostType*/false,
5581 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5582 /*StructField*/true);
5583 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
5584 }
5585 }
5586 }
5587}
5588
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005589void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
Fariborz Jahanianac73ff82007-11-01 17:18:37 +00005590 std::string& S) const {
5591 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5592 S += 'n';
5593 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5594 S += 'N';
5595 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5596 S += 'o';
5597 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5598 S += 'O';
5599 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5600 S += 'R';
5601 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5602 S += 'V';
5603}
5604
Douglas Gregor3ea72692011-08-12 05:46:01 +00005605TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5606 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
5607 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, 0, 0);
5608 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5609 TypeSourceInfo *IdInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
5610 ObjCIdDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5611 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5612 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5613 &Idents.get("id"), IdInfo);
5614 }
5615
5616 return ObjCIdDecl;
Steve Naroff66e9f332007-10-15 14:41:52 +00005617}
5618
Douglas Gregor52e02802011-08-12 06:17:30 +00005619TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5620 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
5621 QualType SelT = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5622 TypeSourceInfo *SelInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(SelT);
5623 ObjCSelDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5624 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5625 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5626 &Idents.get("SEL"), SelInfo);
5627 }
5628 return ObjCSelDecl;
Fariborz Jahanian4bef4622007-10-16 20:40:23 +00005629}
5630
Douglas Gregor0a586182011-08-12 05:59:41 +00005631TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5632 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
5633 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, 0, 0);
5634 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5635 TypeSourceInfo *ClassInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
5636 ObjCClassDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this),
5637 getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5638 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5639 &Idents.get("Class"), ClassInfo);
5640 }
5641
5642 return ObjCClassDecl;
Anders Carlssonf56a7ae2007-10-31 02:53:19 +00005643}
5644
Douglas Gregord53ae832012-01-17 18:09:05 +00005645ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5646 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5647 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5648 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5649 SourceLocation(),
5650 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
5651 /*PrevDecl=*/0,
5652 SourceLocation(), true);
5653 }
5654
5655 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5656}
5657
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005658//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5659// __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5660//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5661
5662static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5663 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
5664 QualType CharPtrType = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5665 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5666 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharPtrType);
5667
5668 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
5669 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5670 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5671 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5672 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5673 TInfo);
5674 return VaListTypeDecl;
5675}
5676
5677static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5678 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
5679 QualType VoidPtrType = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5680 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5681 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VoidPtrType);
5682
5683 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
5684 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5685 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5686 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5687 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5688 TInfo);
5689 return VaListTypeDecl;
5690}
5691
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00005692static TypedefDecl *
5693CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5694 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5695 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5696 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5697 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5698 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5699 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5700 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
5701 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
5702 /*PrevDecl*/0);
5703
5704 VaListTagDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5705 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5706 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5707 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5708 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
5709 } else {
5710 // struct __va_list
5711 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5712 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5713 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5714 }
5715
5716 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5717
5718 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5719 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5720 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5721
5722 // void *__stack;
5723 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5724 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5725
5726 // void *__gr_top;
5727 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5728 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5729
5730 // void *__vr_top;
5731 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5732 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5733
5734 // int __gr_offs;
5735 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5736 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5737
5738 // int __vr_offs;
5739 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5740 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5741
5742 // Create fields
5743 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5744 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5745 VaListTagDecl,
5746 SourceLocation(),
5747 SourceLocation(),
5748 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5749 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5750 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5751 /*Mutable=*/false,
5752 ICIS_NoInit);
5753 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5754 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5755 }
5756 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5757 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5758 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5759
5760 // } __builtin_va_list;
5761 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5762 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5763 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5764 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5765 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5766 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5767
5768 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5769}
5770
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005771static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5772 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5773 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5774
5775 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5776 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5777 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
5778 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5779
5780 const size_t NumFields = 5;
5781 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5782 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5783
5784 // unsigned char gpr;
5785 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5786 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
5787
5788 // unsigned char fpr;
5789 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
5790 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
5791
5792 // unsigned short reserved;
5793 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
5794 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
5795
5796 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5797 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5798 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
5799
5800 // void* reg_save_area;
5801 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5802 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
5803
5804 // Create fields
5805 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5806 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
5807 SourceLocation(),
5808 SourceLocation(),
5809 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5810 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5811 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5812 /*Mutable=*/false,
5813 ICIS_NoInit);
5814 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5815 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5816 }
5817 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5818 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005819 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005820
5821 // } __va_list_tag;
5822 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
5823 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5824 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5825 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5826 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
5827 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5828 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5829 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5830
5831 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5832 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5833 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5834 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5835 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
5836 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5837 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
5838 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5839 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5840 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5841 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5842 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5843 TInfo);
5844
5845 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5846}
5847
5848static TypedefDecl *
5849CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5850 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5851 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5852 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5853 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5854 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
5855 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5856
5857 const size_t NumFields = 4;
5858 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5859 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5860
5861 // unsigned gp_offset;
5862 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5863 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
5864
5865 // unsigned fp_offset;
5866 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
5867 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
5868
5869 // void* overflow_arg_area;
5870 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5871 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
5872
5873 // void* reg_save_area;
5874 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5875 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
5876
5877 // Create fields
5878 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5879 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5880 VaListTagDecl,
5881 SourceLocation(),
5882 SourceLocation(),
5883 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5884 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
5885 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5886 /*Mutable=*/false,
5887 ICIS_NoInit);
5888 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5889 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5890 }
5891 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5892 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00005893 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00005894
5895 // } __va_list_tag;
5896 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
5897 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5898 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5899 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5900 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
5901 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
5902 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
5903 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
5904
5905 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
5906 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
5907 QualType VaListTagArrayType
5908 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
5909 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
5910 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5911 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
5912 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5913 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5914 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5915 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5916 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5917 TInfo);
5918
5919 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5920}
5921
5922static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5923 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
5924 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
5925 QualType IntArrayType
5926 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
5927 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
5928 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
5929 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5930 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5931 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5932 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5933 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(IntArrayType));
5934
5935 return VaListTypedefDecl;
5936}
5937
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00005938static TypedefDecl *
5939CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5940 RecordDecl *VaListDecl;
5941 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5942 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5943 NamespaceDecl *NS;
5944 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5945 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5946 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
5947 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
5948 /*PrevDecl*/0);
5949
5950 VaListDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5951 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5952 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5953 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5954
5955 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
5956
5957 } else {
5958 // struct __va_list {
5959 VaListDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
5960 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5961 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list"));
5962 }
5963
5964 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
5965
5966 // void * __ap;
5967 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5968 VaListDecl,
5969 SourceLocation(),
5970 SourceLocation(),
5971 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
5972 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
5973 /*TInfo=*/0,
5974 /*BitWidth=*/0,
5975 /*Mutable=*/false,
5976 ICIS_NoInit);
5977 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5978 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
5979
5980 // };
5981 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
5982
5983 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
5984 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
5985 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl));
5986
5987 TypedefDecl *VaListTypeDecl
5988 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5989 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5990 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
5991 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
5992 TInfo);
5993
5994 return VaListTypeDecl;
5995}
5996
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00005997static TypedefDecl *
5998CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5999 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6000 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6001 VaListTagDecl = CreateRecordDecl(*Context, TTK_Struct,
6002 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6003 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"));
6004 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6005
6006 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6007 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6008 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6009
6010 // long __gpr;
6011 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6012 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6013
6014 // long __fpr;
6015 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6016 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6017
6018 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6019 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6020 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6021
6022 // void *__reg_save_area;
6023 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6024 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6025
6026 // Create fields
6027 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6028 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6029 VaListTagDecl,
6030 SourceLocation(),
6031 SourceLocation(),
6032 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6033 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/0,
6034 /*BitWidth=*/0,
6035 /*Mutable=*/false,
6036 ICIS_NoInit);
6037 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6038 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6039 }
6040 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6041 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6042 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6043
6044 // } __va_list_tag;
6045 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl
6046 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6047 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6048 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6049 &Context->Idents.get("__va_list_tag"),
6050 Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagType));
6051 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6052 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6053
6054 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6055 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6056 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6057 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6058 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6059 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo
6060 = Context->getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(VaListTagArrayType);
6061 TypedefDecl *VaListTypedefDecl
6062 = TypedefDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6063 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6064 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
6065 &Context->Idents.get("__builtin_va_list"),
6066 TInfo);
6067
6068 return VaListTypedefDecl;
6069}
6070
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006071static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6072 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6073 switch (Kind) {
6074 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6075 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6076 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6077 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00006078 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6079 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006080 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6081 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6082 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6083 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6084 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6085 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Logan Chien57086ce2012-10-10 06:56:20 +00006086 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6087 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Ulrich Weigand47445072013-05-06 16:26:41 +00006088 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6089 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
Meador Inge5d3fb222012-06-16 03:34:49 +00006090 }
6091
6092 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6093}
6094
6095TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
6096 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl)
6097 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
6098
6099 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6100}
6101
Meador Ingecfb60902012-07-01 15:57:25 +00006102QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6103 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6104 // declaration.
6105 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6106 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6107
6108 return VaListTagTy;
6109}
6110
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006111void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006112 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006113 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006114
Ted Kremenek1b0ea822008-01-07 19:49:32 +00006115 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
Steve Narofff73b7842007-10-15 23:35:17 +00006116}
6117
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006118/// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6119/// lookup.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006120TemplateName
6121ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6122 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006123 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6124 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6125
6126 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6127 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6128 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6129
6130 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00006131 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
John McCalld28ae272009-12-02 08:04:21 +00006132 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6133 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6134 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6135 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6136 *Storage++ = D;
6137 }
6138
6139 return TemplateName(OT);
6140}
6141
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006142/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6143/// template name such as \c std::vector.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006144TemplateName
6145ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6146 bool TemplateKeyword,
6147 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
Douglas Gregore29139c2011-03-03 17:04:51 +00006148 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6149
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006150 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006151 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6152 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6153
6154 void *InsertPos = 0;
6155 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6156 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6157 if (!QTN) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006158 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6159 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006160 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6161 }
6162
6163 return TemplateName(QTN);
6164}
6165
6166/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6167/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006168TemplateName
6169ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6170 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006171 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
Douglas Gregor308047d2009-09-09 00:23:06 +00006172 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006173
6174 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6175 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6176
6177 void *InsertPos = 0;
6178 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6179 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6180
6181 if (QTN)
6182 return TemplateName(QTN);
6183
6184 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6185 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006186 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6187 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006188 } else {
6189 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006190 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6191 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006192 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6193 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6194 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6195 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregordc572a32009-03-30 22:58:21 +00006196 }
6197
6198 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6199 return TemplateName(QTN);
6200}
6201
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006202/// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6203/// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6204TemplateName
6205ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006206 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006207 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6208 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6209
6210 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6211 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
6212
6213 void *InsertPos = 0;
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006214 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6215 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006216
6217 if (QTN)
6218 return TemplateName(QTN);
6219
6220 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6221 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006222 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6223 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006224 } else {
6225 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
Richard Smitha5e69762012-08-16 01:19:31 +00006226 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6227 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
Douglas Gregorc42075a2010-02-04 18:10:26 +00006228
6229 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6230 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6231 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6232 (void)CheckQTN;
Douglas Gregor71395fa2009-11-04 00:56:37 +00006233 }
6234
6235 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6236 return TemplateName(QTN);
6237}
6238
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006239TemplateName
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006240ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6241 TemplateName replacement) const {
6242 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6243 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
6244
6245 void *insertPos = 0;
6246 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6247 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6248
6249 if (!subst) {
6250 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6251 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6252 }
6253
6254 return TemplateName(subst);
6255}
6256
6257TemplateName
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006258ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6259 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6260 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6261 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6262 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
6263
6264 void *InsertPos = 0;
6265 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6266 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6267
6268 if (!Subst) {
John McCalld9dfe3a2011-06-30 08:33:18 +00006269 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
Douglas Gregor5590be02011-01-15 06:45:20 +00006270 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6271 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6272 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6273 }
6274
6275 return TemplateName(Subst);
6276}
6277
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006278/// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
Douglas Gregorab138572008-11-03 15:57:00 +00006279/// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6280/// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006281CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006282 switch (Type) {
John McCall48f2d582009-10-23 23:03:21 +00006283 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006284 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6285 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6286 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6287 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6288 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6289 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6290 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6291 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6292 }
6293
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00006294 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
Douglas Gregor8af6e6d2008-11-03 14:12:49 +00006295}
Ted Kremenek77c51b22008-07-24 23:58:27 +00006296
6297//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6298// Type Predicates.
6299//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6300
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006301/// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6302/// garbage collection attribute.
6303///
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006304Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006305 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006306 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6307
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006308 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
John McCall553d45a2011-01-12 00:34:59 +00006309 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6310
6311 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6312 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6313 // as __strong.
6314 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6315 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6316 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6317 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6318 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6319 } else {
6320 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6321 // pointer.
6322#ifndef NDEBUG
6323 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6324 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6325 CT = AT->getElementType();
6326 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6327#endif
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006328 }
Chris Lattnerd60183d2009-02-18 22:53:11 +00006329 return GCAttrs;
Fariborz Jahanian96207692009-02-18 21:49:28 +00006330}
6331
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006332//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6333// Type Compatibility Testing
6334//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattnerb338a6b2007-11-01 05:03:41 +00006335
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006336/// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006337/// compatible.
6338static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6339 const VectorType *RHS) {
John McCallb692a092009-10-22 20:10:53 +00006340 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006341 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006342 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006343}
6344
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006345bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6346 QualType SecondVec) {
6347 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6348 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6349
6350 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6351 return true;
6352
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006353 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6354 // equivalent GCC vector types.
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006355 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6356 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006357 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006358 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
Bob Wilsone6aeebb2010-11-12 17:24:54 +00006359 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6360 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6361 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6362 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00006363 return true;
6364
6365 return false;
6366}
6367
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006368//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6369// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6370//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6371
6372/// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6373/// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00006374bool
6375ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6376 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
Douglas Gregor33b24292012-01-01 18:09:12 +00006377 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006378 return true;
6379 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator PI = rProto->protocol_begin(),
6380 E = rProto->protocol_end(); PI != E; ++PI)
6381 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, *PI))
6382 return true;
6383 return false;
6384}
6385
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006386/// QualifiedIdConformsQualifiedId - compare id<pr,...> with id<pr1,...>
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006387/// return true if lhs's protocols conform to rhs's protocol; false
6388/// otherwise.
6389bool ASTContext::QualifiedIdConformsQualifiedId(QualType lhs, QualType rhs) {
6390 if (lhs->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && rhs->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6391 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(lhs, rhs, false);
6392 return false;
6393}
6394
Dmitri Gribenko4364fcf2012-08-28 02:49:14 +00006395/// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6396/// Class<pr1, ...>.
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006397bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6398 QualType rhs) {
6399 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6400 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6401 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6402
6403 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6404 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6405 bool match = false;
6406 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6407 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6408 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6409 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6410 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6411 match = true;
6412 break;
6413 }
6414 }
6415 if (!match)
6416 return false;
6417 }
6418 return true;
6419}
6420
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006421/// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6422/// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6423bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6424 bool compare) {
6425 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006426 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006427 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6428 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006429 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006430 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6431 return true;
6432
6433 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006434 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006435
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006436 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006437
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006438 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006439 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006440 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6441 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6442 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6443 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6444 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6445 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6446 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian3f8917a2009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006447 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true))
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006448 return false;
6449 }
6450 }
6451 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6452 return true;
6453 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006454 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006455 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6456 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6457 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6458 bool match = false;
6459
6460 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6461 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6462 // through its super class and categories.
6463 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6464 E = rhsOPT->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6465 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6466 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6467 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6468 match = true;
6469 break;
6470 }
6471 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006472 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006473 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6474 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6475 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsQID->qual_begin(),
6476 E = lhsQID->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6477 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6478 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6479 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanian3f8917a2009-08-11 22:02:25 +00006480 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(*I, true)) {
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006481 match = true;
6482 break;
6483 }
6484 }
6485 }
6486 if (!match)
6487 return false;
6488 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006489
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006490 return true;
6491 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006492
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006493 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6494 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6495
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006496 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006497 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006498 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006499 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = lhsOPT->qual_begin(),
6500 E = lhsOPT->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
6501 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = *I;
6502 bool match = false;
6503
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006504 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006505 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6506 // through its super class and categories.
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006507 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6508 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006509 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6510 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6511 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6512 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6513 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6514 match = true;
6515 break;
6516 }
6517 }
6518 if (!match)
6519 return false;
6520 }
Fariborz Jahanianeb7714c2010-11-01 20:47:16 +00006521
6522 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6523 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6524 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6525 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6526 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6527 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6528 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6529 // assume that it is mismatch.
6530 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6531 return false;
6532 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6533 LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6534 E = LHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6535 bool match = false;
6536 ObjCProtocolDecl *lhsProto = (*I);
6537 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator J = rhsQID->qual_begin(),
6538 E = rhsQID->qual_end(); J != E; ++J) {
6539 ObjCProtocolDecl *rhsProto = *J;
6540 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6541 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6542 match = true;
6543 break;
6544 }
6545 }
6546 if (!match)
6547 return false;
6548 }
6549 }
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006550 return true;
6551 }
6552 return false;
6553}
6554
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006555/// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006556/// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6557/// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6558///
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006559bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6560 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006561 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6562 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6563
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00006564 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006565 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6566 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006567 return true;
6568
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006569 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006570 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6571 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006572 false);
Fariborz Jahanian3c7ebc32010-07-19 22:02:22 +00006573
6574 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6575 return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6576 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6577
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006578 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6579 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006580 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006581
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00006582 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006583}
6584
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006585/// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
Chris Lattner57540c52011-04-15 05:22:18 +00006586/// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006587/// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6588/// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6589/// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6590bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6591 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006592 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6593 bool BlockReturnType) {
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006594 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006595 return true;
6596
6597 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6598 return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6599 }
6600
Fariborz Jahanian440a6832010-04-06 17:23:39 +00006601 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006602 return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6603 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6604 false);
6605
6606 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6607 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6608 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6609 if (LHS != RHS) {
6610 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006611 return BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006612 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006613 return !BlockReturnType;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006614 }
6615 else
6616 return true;
6617 }
6618 return false;
6619}
6620
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006621/// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6622/// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6623/// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6624/// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6625static
6626void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6627 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6628 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006629 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006630
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006631 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6632 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6633 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6634 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006635
6636 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6637 unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6638 if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6639 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6640 else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006641 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006642 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6643 LHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006644 InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6645 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6646 }
6647
6648 unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6649 if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
Dan Gohman145f3f12010-04-19 16:39:44 +00006650 ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6651 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006652 for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6653 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6654 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
Chad Rosier6fdf38b2011-08-17 23:08:45 +00006655 } else {
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006656 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006657 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6658 RHSInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahaniandc68f952010-02-12 19:27:33 +00006659 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6660 RHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6661 E = RHSInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I)
6662 if (InheritedProtocolSet.count((*I)))
6663 IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back((*I));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006664 }
6665}
6666
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006667/// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6668/// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6669/// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6670/// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6671QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006672 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6673 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6674 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6675 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6676 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6677 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
Douglas Gregor0b144e12011-12-15 00:29:59 +00006678 if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006679 return QualType();
6680
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006681 do {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006682 LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006683 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006684 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006685 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6686
6687 QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6688 if (!Protocols.empty())
6689 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6690 Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6691 return Result;
Fariborz Jahanian6c5a8e22009-10-30 01:13:23 +00006692 }
Fariborz Jahanianb1071432011-04-18 21:16:59 +00006693 } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
Fariborz Jahanianef8b8ce2009-10-27 23:02:38 +00006694
6695 return QualType();
6696}
6697
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006698bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6699 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6700 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6701 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6702
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006703 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6704 // the LHS.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006705 if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006706 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006707
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006708 // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS. If the LHS is not
6709 // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
Steve Naroffc277ad12009-07-18 15:33:26 +00006710 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006711 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006712
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006713 // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. If the RHS doesn't,
6714 // more detailed analysis is required.
6715 if (RHS->getNumProtocols() == 0) {
6716 // OK, if LHS is a superclass of RHS *and*
6717 // this superclass is assignment compatible with LHS.
6718 // false otherwise.
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006719 bool IsSuperClass =
6720 LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6721 if (IsSuperClass) {
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006722 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6723 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6724 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6725 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6726 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
Fariborz Jahanian240400b2011-04-12 16:34:14 +00006727 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
Fariborz Jahanian4806ff82011-04-08 18:25:29 +00006728 // If super class has no protocols, it is not a match.
6729 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6730 return false;
6731
6732 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6733 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
6734 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6735 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6736 ObjCProtocolDecl *LHSProto = (*LHSPI);
6737
6738 for (llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*,8>::iterator I =
6739 SuperClassInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6740 E = SuperClassInheritedProtocols.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6741 ObjCProtocolDecl *SuperClassProto = (*I);
6742 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6743 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6744 break;
6745 }
6746 }
6747 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6748 return false;
6749 }
6750 return true;
6751 }
6752 return false;
6753 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006754
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006755 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator LHSPI = LHS->qual_begin(),
6756 LHSPE = LHS->qual_end();
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006757 LHSPI != LHSPE; LHSPI++) {
6758 bool RHSImplementsProtocol = false;
6759
6760 // If the RHS doesn't implement the protocol on the left, the types
6761 // are incompatible.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006762 for (ObjCObjectType::qual_iterator RHSPI = RHS->qual_begin(),
6763 RHSPE = RHS->qual_end();
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006764 RHSPI != RHSPE; RHSPI++) {
6765 if ((*RHSPI)->lookupProtocolNamed((*LHSPI)->getIdentifier())) {
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006766 RHSImplementsProtocol = true;
Steve Narofffac5bc92009-07-16 16:21:02 +00006767 break;
6768 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006769 }
6770 // FIXME: For better diagnostics, consider passing back the protocol name.
6771 if (!RHSImplementsProtocol)
6772 return false;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006773 }
Steve Naroff114aecb2009-03-01 16:12:44 +00006774 // The RHS implements all protocols listed on the LHS.
6775 return true;
Chris Lattner49af6a42008-04-07 06:51:04 +00006776}
6777
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006778bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6779 // get the "pointed to" types
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006780 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6781 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006782
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006783 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006784 return false;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006785
6786 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6787 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
Steve Naroffb7605152009-02-12 17:52:19 +00006788}
6789
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00006790bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6791 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6792 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6793 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6794}
6795
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006796/// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006797/// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006798/// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00006799/// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006800bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6801 bool CompareUnqualified) {
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00006802 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00006803 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6804
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006805 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006806}
6807
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006808bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
Fariborz Jahanianc87c8792011-07-12 23:20:13 +00006809 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianc0f6af22011-07-12 22:05:16 +00006810}
6811
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006812bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6813 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6814}
6815
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006816/// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6817/// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6818/// QualType()
6819QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6820 bool OfBlockPointer,
6821 bool Unqualified) {
6822 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6823 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6824 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
6825 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
6826 itend = UD->field_end(); it != itend; ++it) {
Peter Collingbourne19b961d2010-12-02 21:00:06 +00006827 QualType ET = it->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006828 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6829 if (!MT.isNull())
6830 return MT;
6831 }
6832 }
6833 }
6834
6835 return QualType();
6836}
6837
6838/// mergeFunctionArgumentTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6839/// argument types
6840QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionArgumentTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6841 bool OfBlockPointer,
6842 bool Unqualified) {
6843 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6844 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6845 // type is compatible with a union member
6846 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6847 Unqualified);
6848 if (!lmerge.isNull())
6849 return lmerge;
6850
6851 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6852 Unqualified);
6853 if (!rmerge.isNull())
6854 return rmerge;
6855
6856 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6857}
6858
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006859QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006860 bool OfBlockPointer,
6861 bool Unqualified) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006862 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6863 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006864 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6865 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006866 bool allLTypes = true;
6867 bool allRTypes = true;
6868
6869 // Check return type
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006870 QualType retType;
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006871 if (OfBlockPointer) {
6872 QualType RHS = rbase->getResultType();
6873 QualType LHS = lbase->getResultType();
6874 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6875 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6876 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00006877 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
Fariborz Jahanian17825972011-02-11 18:46:17 +00006878 }
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00006879 else
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006880 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getResultType(), rbase->getResultType(), false,
6881 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006882 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006883
6884 if (Unqualified)
6885 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6886
6887 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getResultType());
6888 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getResultType());
6889 if (Unqualified) {
6890 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6891 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6892 }
6893
6894 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006895 allLTypes = false;
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006896 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006897 allRTypes = false;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006898
Daniel Dunbaredd5bae2010-04-28 16:20:58 +00006899 // FIXME: double check this
6900 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6901 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
6902 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
Rafael Espindolac50c27c2010-03-30 20:24:48 +00006903 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
6904 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006905
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006906 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006907 if (!isSameCallConv(lbaseInfo.getCC(), rbaseInfo.getCC()))
Douglas Gregor8c940862010-01-18 17:14:39 +00006908 return QualType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006909
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006910 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
Eli Friedmanc5b20b52011-04-09 08:18:08 +00006911 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
6912 return QualType();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006913 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
6914 return QualType();
6915
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006916 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
6917 return QualType();
6918
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006919 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
6920 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00006921
Rafael Espindola8778c282012-11-29 16:09:03 +00006922 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6923 allLTypes = false;
6924 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
6925 allRTypes = false;
6926
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00006927 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006928
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006929 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006930 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
6931 "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006932 unsigned lproto_nargs = lproto->getNumArgs();
6933 unsigned rproto_nargs = rproto->getNumArgs();
6934
6935 // Compatible functions must have the same number of arguments
6936 if (lproto_nargs != rproto_nargs)
6937 return QualType();
6938
6939 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
6940 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
6941 return QualType();
6942
Argyrios Kyrtzidis22a37352008-10-26 16:43:14 +00006943 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
6944 return QualType();
6945
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006946 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
6947 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
6948 return QualType();
6949
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006950 // Check argument compatibility
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00006951 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006952 for (unsigned i = 0; i < lproto_nargs; i++) {
6953 QualType largtype = lproto->getArgType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
6954 QualType rargtype = rproto->getArgType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
Peter Collingbournea99fdcf2010-10-24 18:30:18 +00006955 QualType argtype = mergeFunctionArgumentTypes(largtype, rargtype,
6956 OfBlockPointer,
6957 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006958 if (argtype.isNull()) return QualType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006959
6960 if (Unqualified)
6961 argtype = argtype.getUnqualifiedType();
6962
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006963 types.push_back(argtype);
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00006964 if (Unqualified) {
6965 largtype = largtype.getUnqualifiedType();
6966 rargtype = rargtype.getUnqualifiedType();
6967 }
6968
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00006969 if (getCanonicalType(argtype) != getCanonicalType(largtype))
6970 allLTypes = false;
6971 if (getCanonicalType(argtype) != getCanonicalType(rargtype))
6972 allRTypes = false;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006973 }
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00006974
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006975 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
6976 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00006977
6978 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
6979 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00006980 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006981 }
6982
6983 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
6984 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
6985
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00006986 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006987 if (proto) {
Sebastian Redl5068f77ac2009-05-27 22:11:52 +00006988 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00006989 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
6990 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
6991 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
6992 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
6993 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
6994 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
6995 unsigned proto_nargs = proto->getNumArgs();
6996 for (unsigned i = 0; i < proto_nargs; ++i) {
6997 QualType argTy = proto->getArgType(i);
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00006998
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00006999 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007000 // to pass enum values.
Eli Friedman448ce402012-08-30 00:44:15 +00007001 if (const EnumType *Enum = argTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7002 argTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7003 if (argTy.isNull())
7004 return QualType();
7005 }
Douglas Gregor2973d402010-02-03 19:27:29 +00007006
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007007 if (argTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7008 getCanonicalType(argTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
7009 return QualType();
7010 }
7011
7012 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7013 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007014
7015 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7016 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007017 return getFunctionType(retType,
7018 ArrayRef<QualType>(proto->arg_type_begin(),
7019 proto->getNumArgs()),
7020 EPI);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007021 }
7022
7023 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7024 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
John McCall8c6b56f2010-12-15 01:06:38 +00007025 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007026}
7027
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007028/// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7029static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7030 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7031 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7032 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7033 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7034 // type.
7035 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7036 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7037 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7038 return other;
7039
7040 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7041 // integral type of the same size.
7042 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7043 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7044 return other;
7045
7046 return QualType();
7047}
7048
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007049QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007050 bool OfBlockPointer,
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007051 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
Bill Wendlingdb4e3492007-12-03 07:33:35 +00007052 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7053 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7054 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007055 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7056 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007057 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7058 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007059
7060 if (Unqualified) {
7061 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7062 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7063 }
Douglas Gregor21e771e2010-02-03 21:02:30 +00007064
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007065 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7066 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7067
7068 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7069 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7070 return LHS;
7071
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007072 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00007073 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7074 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007075 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7076 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7077 // mismatch.
7078 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
John McCall31168b02011-06-15 23:02:42 +00007079 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7080 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007081 return QualType();
7082
7083 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7084 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7085 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7086 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7087 // qualified __strong.
7088 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7089 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7090 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7091
7092 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7093 return QualType();
7094
7095 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7096 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7097 }
7098 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7099 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7100 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007101 return QualType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00007102 }
7103
7104 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007105
Eli Friedmandcca6332009-06-01 01:22:52 +00007106 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7107 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007108
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007109 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7110 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7111 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7112 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
Eli Friedman16f90962008-02-12 08:23:06 +00007113
7114 // Same as above for arrays
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007115 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7116 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7117 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7118 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007119
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007120 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7121 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7122 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7123
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00007124 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7125 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7126 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007127
Chris Lattner95554662008-04-07 05:43:21 +00007128 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007129 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007130 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7131 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007132 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007133 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007134 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007135 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
John McCall433c2e62013-03-21 00:10:07 +00007136 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
Eli Friedmana7bf7ed2008-02-12 08:46:17 +00007137 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007138 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
Fariborz Jahanian194904e2012-01-26 17:08:50 +00007139 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7140 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7141 return LHS;
7142 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7143 return RHS;
7144 }
Fariborz Jahanian26d83712012-01-26 00:45:38 +00007145
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007146 return QualType();
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007147 }
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007148
Steve Naroffc6edcbd2008-01-09 22:43:08 +00007149 // The canonical type classes match.
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007150 switch (LHSClass) {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007151#define TYPE(Class, Base)
7152#define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
John McCallbd8d9bd2010-03-01 23:49:17 +00007153#define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007154#define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7155#define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7156#include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007157 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007158
Richard Smith27d807c2013-04-30 13:56:41 +00007159 case Type::Auto:
Sebastian Redl0f8b23f2009-03-16 23:22:08 +00007160 case Type::LValueReference:
7161 case Type::RValueReference:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007162 case Type::MemberPointer:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007163 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007164
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007165 case Type::ObjCInterface:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007166 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7167 case Type::VariableArray:
7168 case Type::FunctionProto:
7169 case Type::ExtVector:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007170 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007171
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007172 case Type::Pointer:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007173 {
7174 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007175 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7176 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007177 if (Unqualified) {
7178 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7179 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7180 }
7181 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7182 Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007183 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007184 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007185 return LHS;
Eli Friedman091a9ac2009-06-02 05:28:56 +00007186 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007187 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007188 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7189 }
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007190 case Type::BlockPointer:
7191 {
7192 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00007193 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7194 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007195 if (Unqualified) {
7196 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7197 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7198 }
7199 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7200 Unqualified);
Steve Naroff68e167d2008-12-10 17:49:55 +00007201 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7202 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7203 return LHS;
7204 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7205 return RHS;
7206 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7207 }
Eli Friedman0dfb8892011-10-06 23:00:33 +00007208 case Type::Atomic:
7209 {
7210 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7211 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7212 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7213 if (Unqualified) {
7214 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7215 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7216 }
7217 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7218 Unqualified);
7219 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7220 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7221 return LHS;
7222 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7223 return RHS;
7224 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7225 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007226 case Type::ConstantArray:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007227 {
7228 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7229 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7230 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7231 return QualType();
7232
7233 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7234 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007235 if (Unqualified) {
7236 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7237 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7238 }
7239
7240 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007241 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007242 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7243 return LHS;
7244 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7245 return RHS;
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007246 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7247 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7248 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7249 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007250 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7251 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007252 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7253 return LHS;
7254 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7255 return RHS;
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007256 if (LVAT) {
7257 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7258 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7259 // has to be different.
7260 return LHS;
7261 }
7262 if (RVAT) {
7263 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7264 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7265 // has to be different.
7266 return RHS;
7267 }
Eli Friedman3e62c212008-08-22 01:48:21 +00007268 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7269 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
Douglas Gregor04318252009-07-06 15:59:29 +00007270 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7271 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007272 }
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007273 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
Douglas Gregor17ea3f52010-07-29 15:18:02 +00007274 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007275 case Type::Record:
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007276 case Type::Enum:
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007277 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerfd652912008-01-14 05:45:46 +00007278 case Type::Builtin:
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007279 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007280 return QualType();
Daniel Dunbar804c0442009-01-28 21:22:12 +00007281 case Type::Complex:
7282 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7283 return QualType();
Chris Lattner7bbd3d72008-04-07 05:55:38 +00007284 case Type::Vector:
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007285 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
John McCall44c064b2010-03-12 23:14:13 +00007286 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7287 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007288 return LHS;
Chris Lattner465fa322008-10-05 17:34:18 +00007289 return QualType();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007290 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7291 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
Eli Friedmancad96382009-02-27 23:04:43 +00007292 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7293 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00007294 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7295 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7296 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
Steve Naroff7a7814c2009-02-21 16:18:07 +00007297 return LHS;
7298
Eli Friedman47f77112008-08-22 00:56:42 +00007299 return QualType();
Cedric Venet4fc88b72009-02-21 17:14:49 +00007300 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007301 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007302 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7303 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7304 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
Fariborz Jahanian90186f82011-03-14 16:07:00 +00007305 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7306 BlockReturnType))
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007307 return LHS;
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00007308 return QualType();
7309 }
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00007310 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7311 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00007312 return LHS;
7313
Steve Naroffc68cfcf2008-12-10 22:14:21 +00007314 return QualType();
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007315 }
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007316 }
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00007317
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007318 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
Steve Naroff32e44c02007-10-15 20:41:53 +00007319}
Ted Kremenekfc581a92007-10-31 17:10:13 +00007320
Fariborz Jahanian97676972011-09-28 21:52:05 +00007321bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7322 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7323 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
7324 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedArgs() !=
7325 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedArgs())
7326 return false;
7327 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7328 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7329 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7330 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7331 if (FromEPI.ConsumedArguments && ToEPI.ConsumedArguments)
7332 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
7333 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
7334 if (FromEPI.ConsumedArguments[ArgIdx] !=
7335 ToEPI.ConsumedArguments[ArgIdx])
7336 return false;
7337 }
7338 return true;
7339}
7340
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007341/// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7342/// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7343/// return types.
7344QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7345 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7346 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7347 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7348 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7349 return LHS;
7350 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7351 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7352 return QualType();
7353 QualType OldReturnType =
7354 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getResultType();
7355 QualType NewReturnType =
7356 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getResultType();
7357 QualType ResReturnType =
7358 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7359 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7360 return QualType();
7361 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7362 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7363 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7364 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7365 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007366 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7367 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007368 QualType ResultType
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007369 = getFunctionType(OldReturnType,
7370 ArrayRef<QualType>(FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7371 FPT->getNumArgs()),
7372 EPI);
Fariborz Jahanianf633ebd2010-05-19 21:37:30 +00007373 return ResultType;
7374 }
7375 }
7376 return QualType();
7377 }
7378
7379 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7380 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7381 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7382 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7383 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7384 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7385 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7386 return QualType();
7387
7388 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7389 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7390 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7391 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7392 // qualified __strong.
7393 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7394 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7395 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7396
7397 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7398 return QualType();
7399
7400 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7401 return LHS;
7402 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7403 return RHS;
7404 return QualType();
7405 }
7406
7407 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7408 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7409 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7410 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7411 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7412 return LHS;
7413 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7414 return RHS;
7415 }
7416 return QualType();
7417}
7418
Chris Lattner4ba0cef2008-04-07 07:01:58 +00007419//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007420// Integer Predicates
7421//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner3c919712009-01-16 07:15:35 +00007422
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007423unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00007424 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
Eli Friedmanee275c82009-12-10 22:29:29 +00007425 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00007426 if (T->isBooleanType())
7427 return 1;
Eli Friedman1efaaea2009-02-13 02:31:07 +00007428 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007429 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7430}
7431
Abramo Bagnara13640492012-09-09 10:21:24 +00007432QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00007433 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007434
7435 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7436 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7437 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007438 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007439
7440 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7441 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007442 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00007443
7444 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7445 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007446 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7447 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7448 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7449 return UnsignedCharTy;
7450 case BuiltinType::Short:
7451 return UnsignedShortTy;
7452 case BuiltinType::Int:
7453 return UnsignedIntTy;
7454 case BuiltinType::Long:
7455 return UnsignedLongTy;
7456 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7457 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattnerf122cef2009-04-30 02:43:43 +00007458 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7459 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007460 default:
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007461 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
Eli Friedman4f89ccb2008-06-28 06:23:08 +00007462 }
7463}
7464
Argyrios Kyrtzidis65ad5692010-10-24 17:26:36 +00007465ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7466
Richard Smith1fa5d642013-05-11 05:45:24 +00007467void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7468 QualType ReturnType) {}
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007469
7470//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7471// Builtin Type Computation
7472//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7473
7474/// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007475/// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7476/// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7477/// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7478/// a vector of "i*".
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007479///
7480/// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7481/// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007482static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007483 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007484 bool &RequiresICE,
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007485 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007486 // Modifiers.
7487 int HowLong = 0;
7488 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007489 RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007490
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007491 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007492 bool Done = false;
7493 while (!Done) {
7494 switch (*Str++) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007495 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007496 case 'I':
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007497 RequiresICE = true;
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007498 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007499 case 'S':
7500 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7501 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7502 Signed = true;
7503 break;
7504 case 'U':
7505 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7506 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7507 Unsigned = true;
7508 break;
7509 case 'L':
7510 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7511 ++HowLong;
7512 break;
7513 }
7514 }
7515
7516 QualType Type;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007517
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007518 // Read the base type.
7519 switch (*Str++) {
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007520 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007521 case 'v':
7522 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7523 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7524 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7525 break;
7526 case 'f':
7527 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7528 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7529 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7530 break;
7531 case 'd':
7532 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7533 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7534 if (HowLong)
7535 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7536 else
7537 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7538 break;
7539 case 's':
7540 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7541 if (Unsigned)
7542 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7543 else
7544 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7545 break;
7546 case 'i':
7547 if (HowLong == 3)
7548 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7549 else if (HowLong == 2)
7550 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7551 else if (HowLong == 1)
7552 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7553 else
7554 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7555 break;
7556 case 'c':
7557 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7558 if (Signed)
7559 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7560 else if (Unsigned)
7561 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7562 else
7563 Type = Context.CharTy;
7564 break;
7565 case 'b': // boolean
7566 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7567 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7568 break;
7569 case 'z': // size_t.
7570 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7571 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7572 break;
7573 case 'F':
7574 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7575 break;
Fariborz Jahaniand11da7e2010-11-09 21:38:20 +00007576 case 'G':
7577 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7578 break;
7579 case 'H':
7580 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7581 break;
Fariborz Jahaniancb6c8672013-01-04 18:45:40 +00007582 case 'M':
7583 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7584 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007585 case 'a':
7586 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7587 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7588 break;
7589 case 'A':
7590 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7591 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7592 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7593 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
7594 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7595 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7596 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7597 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7598 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7599 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007600 if (Type->isArrayType())
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007601 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007602 else
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007603 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007604 break;
7605 case 'V': {
7606 char *End;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007607 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7608 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007609 Str = End;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007610
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007611 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7612 RequiresICE, false);
7613 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007614
7615 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
Chris Lattner37141f42010-06-23 06:00:24 +00007616 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
Bob Wilsonaeb56442010-11-10 21:56:12 +00007617 VectorType::GenericVector);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007618 break;
7619 }
Douglas Gregorfed66992012-06-07 18:08:25 +00007620 case 'E': {
7621 char *End;
7622
7623 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7624 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7625
7626 Str = End;
7627
7628 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7629 false);
7630 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7631 break;
7632 }
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007633 case 'X': {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007634 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7635 false);
7636 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
Douglas Gregor40ef7c52009-09-28 21:45:01 +00007637 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7638 break;
Fariborz Jahanian73952fc2011-08-23 23:33:09 +00007639 }
7640 case 'Y' : {
7641 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7642 break;
7643 }
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007644 case 'P':
Douglas Gregor27821ce2009-07-07 16:35:42 +00007645 Type = Context.getFILEType();
7646 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007647 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007648 return QualType();
7649 }
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007650 break;
Chris Lattnera58b3af2009-07-28 22:49:34 +00007651 case 'J':
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007652 if (Signed)
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007653 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007654 else
7655 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7656
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007657 if (Type.isNull()) {
Mike Stump93246cc2009-07-28 23:57:15 +00007658 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
Mike Stump2adb4da2009-07-28 23:47:15 +00007659 return QualType();
7660 }
7661 break;
Rafael Espindola6cfa82b2011-11-13 21:51:09 +00007662 case 'K':
7663 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7664 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7665
7666 if (Type.isNull()) {
7667 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7668 return QualType();
7669 }
7670 break;
Eli Friedman4e91899e2012-11-27 02:58:24 +00007671 case 'p':
7672 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7673 break;
Mike Stumpa4de80b2009-07-28 02:25:19 +00007674 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007675
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007676 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7677 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007678 while (!Done) {
John McCallb8b94662010-03-12 04:21:28 +00007679 switch (char c = *Str++) {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007680 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7681 case '*':
7682 case '&': {
7683 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7684 // qualified with an address space.
7685 char *End;
7686 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7687 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7688 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7689 Str = End;
7690 }
7691 if (c == '*')
7692 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7693 else
7694 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7695 break;
7696 }
7697 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7698 case 'C':
7699 Type = Type.withConst();
7700 break;
7701 case 'D':
7702 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7703 break;
Ted Kremenekf2a2f5f2012-01-20 21:40:12 +00007704 case 'R':
7705 Type = Type.withRestrict();
7706 break;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007707 }
7708 }
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007709
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007710 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
Chris Lattner84733392010-10-01 07:13:18 +00007711 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007712
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007713 return Type;
7714}
7715
7716/// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007717QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007718 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007719 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
Chris Lattnerdc226c22010-10-01 22:42:38 +00007720 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007721
Chris Lattner0e62c1c2011-07-23 10:55:15 +00007722 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007723
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007724 bool RequiresICE = false;
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007725 Error = GE_None;
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007726 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7727 RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007728 if (Error != GE_None)
7729 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007730
7731 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7732
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007733 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007734 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007735 if (Error != GE_None)
7736 return QualType();
7737
Chris Lattnerbd6e6932010-10-01 22:53:11 +00007738 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7739 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7740 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7741 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7742
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007743 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
7744 if (Ty->isArrayType())
7745 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007746
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007747 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7748 }
7749
7750 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7751 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7752
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007753 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI;
7754 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7755
7756 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7757
7758 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7759 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7760 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
Douglas Gregor36c569f2010-02-21 22:15:06 +00007761
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007762 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +00007763 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7764 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
John McCalldb40c7f2010-12-14 08:05:40 +00007765
Jordan Rose5c382722013-03-08 21:51:21 +00007766 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
Chris Lattnerecd79c62009-06-14 00:45:47 +00007767}
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +00007768
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007769GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
7770 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7771
7772 Linkage L = FD->getLinkage();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007773 switch (L) {
7774 case NoLinkage:
7775 case InternalLinkage:
7776 case UniqueExternalLinkage:
7777 return GVA_Internal;
7778
7779 case ExternalLinkage:
7780 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7781 case TSK_Undeclared:
7782 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7783 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7784 break;
7785
7786 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7787 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
7788
7789 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7790 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7791 External = GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
7792 break;
7793 }
7794 }
7795
7796 if (!FD->isInlined())
7797 return External;
7798
David Blaikiebbafb8a2012-03-11 07:00:24 +00007799 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007800 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7801 // externally visible.
7802 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7803 return External;
7804
7805 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
7806 return GVA_C99Inline;
7807 }
7808
7809 // C++0x [temp.explicit]p9:
7810 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7811 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7812 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7813 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7814 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
7815 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
7816 == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration)
7817 return GVA_C99Inline;
7818
7819 return GVA_CXXInline;
7820}
7821
7822GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
7823 // If this is a static data member, compute the kind of template
7824 // specialization. Otherwise, this variable is not part of a
7825 // template.
7826 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = TSK_Undeclared;
7827 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
7828 TSK = VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind();
7829
7830 Linkage L = VD->getLinkage();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007831
7832 switch (L) {
7833 case NoLinkage:
7834 case InternalLinkage:
7835 case UniqueExternalLinkage:
7836 return GVA_Internal;
7837
7838 case ExternalLinkage:
7839 switch (TSK) {
7840 case TSK_Undeclared:
7841 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7842 return GVA_StrongExternal;
7843
7844 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7845 llvm_unreachable("Variable should not be instantiated");
7846 // Fall through to treat this like any other instantiation.
7847
7848 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7849 return GVA_ExplicitTemplateInstantiation;
7850
7851 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7852 return GVA_TemplateInstantiation;
7853 }
7854 }
7855
David Blaikie8a40f702012-01-17 06:56:22 +00007856 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007857}
7858
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc9049332010-07-29 20:08:05 +00007859bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007860 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
7861 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
7862 return false;
Richard Smith5205a8c2013-04-01 20:22:16 +00007863 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7864 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
7865 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
7866 return false;
7867 } else
7868 return false;
7869
7870 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
7871 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007872 return false;
7873
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007874 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
7875 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
7876 return false;
7877
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007878 // Aliases and used decls are required.
7879 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
7880 return true;
7881
7882 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
7883 // Forward declarations aren't required.
Alexis Hunt4a8ea102011-05-06 20:44:56 +00007884 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
Nick Lewycky26da4dd2011-07-18 05:26:13 +00007885 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007886
7887 // Constructors and destructors are required.
7888 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
7889 return true;
7890
John McCall6bd2a892013-01-25 22:31:03 +00007891 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
7892 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
7893 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
7894 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
7895 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
7896 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
7897 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
7898 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
7899 return true;
7900 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007901 }
7902 }
7903
7904 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
7905
7906 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
7907 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
7908 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
7909 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_C99Inline ||
Anton Yartsev79de4d42012-02-02 06:06:34 +00007910 Linkage == GVA_CXXInline || Linkage == GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007911 return false;
7912 return true;
7913 }
Douglas Gregor87d81242011-09-10 00:22:34 +00007914
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007915 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
7916 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
7917
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6e03a742010-07-29 20:07:52 +00007918 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly)
7919 return false;
7920
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007921 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007922 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007923 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_TemplateInstantiation)
7924 return true;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007925
Richard Smitha0e5e542012-11-12 21:38:00 +00007926 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
7927 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
7928 return true;
7929
7930 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
7931 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
7932 return true;
7933
7934 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc81af032010-07-29 18:15:58 +00007935}
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007936
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007937CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCXXMethodCallConv(bool isVariadic) {
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007938 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007939 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(isVariadic);
7940}
7941
7942CallingConv ASTContext::getCanonicalCallConv(CallingConv CC) const {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007943 if (CC == CC_C && !LangOpts.MRTD &&
7944 getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMemberFunctionCCDefault())
Timur Iskhodzhanovc5098ad2012-07-12 09:50:54 +00007945 return CC_Default;
7946 return CC;
Charles Davis99202b32010-11-09 18:04:24 +00007947}
7948
Jay Foad39c79802011-01-12 09:06:06 +00007949bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
Anders Carlsson60a62632010-11-25 01:51:53 +00007950 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
7951 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
7952}
7953
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007954MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007955 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
Tim Northover9bb857a2013-01-31 12:13:10 +00007956 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007957 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
7958 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
7959 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007960 return createItaniumMangleContext(*this, getDiagnostics());
John McCall359b8852013-01-25 22:30:49 +00007961 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007962 return createMicrosoftMangleContext(*this, getDiagnostics());
7963 }
David Blaikie83d382b2011-09-23 05:06:16 +00007964 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
Peter Collingbourne0ff0b372011-01-13 18:57:25 +00007965}
7966
Charles Davis53c59df2010-08-16 03:33:14 +00007967CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00007968
7969size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
Ted Kremenek7d39c9a2011-07-27 18:41:12 +00007970 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize()
7971 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts)
7972 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions)
7973 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls)
7974 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits)
7975 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs)
7976 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromStaticDataMember)
7977 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl)
7978 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl)
7979 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl)
7980 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods)
7981 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types)
Francois Pichet00c7e6c2011-08-14 03:52:19 +00007982 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes)
Francois Pichet57928252011-08-14 14:28:49 +00007983 + llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
Ted Kremenekf5df0ce2011-04-28 04:53:38 +00007984}
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00007985
David Blaikie095deba2012-11-14 01:52:05 +00007986void ASTContext::addUnnamedTag(const TagDecl *Tag) {
7987 // FIXME: This mangling should be applied to function local classes too
7988 if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl() ||
7989 !isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent()) || Tag->getLinkage() != ExternalLinkage)
7990 return;
7991
7992 std::pair<llvm::DenseMap<const DeclContext *, unsigned>::iterator, bool> P =
7993 UnnamedMangleContexts.insert(std::make_pair(Tag->getParent(), 0));
7994 UnnamedMangleNumbers.insert(std::make_pair(Tag, P.first->second++));
7995}
7996
7997int ASTContext::getUnnamedTagManglingNumber(const TagDecl *Tag) const {
7998 llvm::DenseMap<const TagDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
7999 UnnamedMangleNumbers.find(Tag);
8000 return I != UnnamedMangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : -1;
8001}
8002
Douglas Gregor63798542012-02-20 19:44:39 +00008003unsigned ASTContext::getLambdaManglingNumber(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator) {
8004 CXXRecordDecl *Lambda = CallOperator->getParent();
8005 return LambdaMangleContexts[Lambda->getDeclContext()]
8006 .getManglingNumber(CallOperator);
8007}
8008
8009
Ted Kremenek540017e2011-10-06 05:00:56 +00008010void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8011 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8012}
8013
8014unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8015 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8016 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8017 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8018 return I->second;
8019}